®
2016
OWNER’S MANUAL
FIAT 500e
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
VEHICLES SOLD IN CANADA
With respect to any Vehicles Sold in Canada, the name FCA
US LLC shall be deemed to be deleted and the name FCA
Canada Inc. used in substitution therefore.
DRIVING AND ALCOHOL
Drunken driving is one of the most frequent causes of
accidents.
Your driving ability can be seriously impaired with blood
alcohol levels far below the legal minimum. If you are
drinking, don’t drive. Ride with a designated nondrinking driver, call a cab, a friend, or use public transportation.
This manual illustrates and describes the operation of
features and equipment that are either standard or optional on this vehicle. This manual may also include a
description of features and equipment that are no longer
available or were not ordered on this vehicle. Please
disregard any features and equipment described in this
manual that are not on this vehicle.
FCA US LLC reserves the right to make changes in design
and specifications, and/or make additions to or improvements to its products without imposing any obligation
upon itself to install them on products previously manufactured.
WARNING!
Driving after drinking can lead to an accident.
Your perceptions are less sharp, your reflexes are
slower, and your judgment is impaired when you
have been drinking. Never drink and then drive.
Copyright © 2015 FCA US LLC
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
SECTION
TABLE OF CONTENTS
PAGE
1
1
INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
2
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
2
3
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
3
4
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
4
5
STARTING AND OPERATING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
5
6
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
6
7
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
7
8
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323
8
9
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329
9
10
INDEX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
10
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
INTRODUCTION
CONTENTS
䡵 INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 䡵 VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER . . . . . . . .7
䡵 HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 䡵 VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS/ALTERATIONS . . . .8
䡵 WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
1
4 INTRODUCTION
INTRODUCTION
The enclosed Warranty Information lists the services that
FCA US LLC offers to its customers:
Congratulations on selecting your new FIAT 500e. Be
assured that your 500e represents an elegant marriage of • The Warranty Certificate with terms and conditions for
technology and Italian styling that is as good for the
maintaining its validity
environment as is fun to drive!
• The range of additional services available to FCA US
This Owner’s Manual has been prepared with the assisLLC customers
tance of service and engineering specialists to acquaint
NOTE: After reviewing the owner information, it
you with the operation, understanding and maintenance
should be stored in the vehicle for convenient referencof your 500e. It is supplemented by Warranty Informaing and remain with the vehicle when sold.
tion, and various customer-oriented documents. Please
take the time to read these publications carefully. Follow- When it comes to service, remember that your authorized
ing the instructions and recommendations in this manual dealer knows your vehicle best, has factory-trained techwill help assure safe and enjoyable operation of your nicians and genuine MOPAR® parts, and cares about
vehicle.
your satisfaction.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
INTRODUCTION 5
Consult the following table for a description of the
Consult the Table of Contents to determine which section symbols that may be used on your vehicle or throughout
this Owner’s Manual:
contains the information you desire.
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
Since the specification of your vehicle depends on the
items of equipment ordered, certain descriptions and
illustrations may differ from your vehicle’s equipment.
The detailed index at the back of this Owner’s Manual
contains a complete listing of all subjects.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
1
6 INTRODUCTION
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
INTRODUCTION 7
WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS
1
This Owner’s Manual contains WARNINGS against
operating procedures that could result in a collision,
bodily injury and/or death. It also contains CAUTIONS
against procedures that could result in damage to your
vehicle. If you do not read this entire Owner’s Manual,
you may miss important information. Observe all Warnings and Cautions.
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) is found on the
left front corner of the instrument panel, visible through
the windshield. This number also appears engraved on
the right front door sill under the sill scuff plate, on an
adhesive label applied to the right door opening on the
B-Pillar, on the vehicle registration and title.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Vehicle Identification Number
8 INTRODUCTION
VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS/ALTERATIONS
WARNING!
Any modifications or alterations to this vehicle could
seriously affect its roadworthiness and safety and
may lead to a collision resulting in serious injury or
death.
Stamped VIN Location
NOTE: It is illegal to remove or alter the VIN.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
2
CONTENTS
䡵 IMPORTANT VEHICLE INFORMATION . . . . . . .12
▫ Smartphone Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
▫ High Voltage Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12 䡵 ELECTRIC SYSTEM OPERATION . . . . . . . . . . . .19
䡵 500e ELECTRIC VEHICLE FEATURES . . . . . . . . .14
▫ Audible Pedestrian Warning System . . . . . . . . .14
▫ Single-Speed Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
▫ Auto Park. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
▫ E-Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
▫ Climate Control (HVAC System) . . . . . . . . . . . .16
▫ Electric Air Conditioning Compressor . . . . . . . .16
▫ Electric Power Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
▫ Level 1 Charging (120V — Requires
NEMA 5–15 Outlet) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
▫ Level 2 Charging (240V — Requires A 40 Amp
Circuit Breaker Or Greater) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .19
▫ Charge Times . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20
▫ Vehicle Charge Cord . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20
▫ EVSE Operation And Status Information . . . . . .22
▫ Charging The High Voltage Battery. . . . . . . . . .24
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
10 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
▫ Vehicle Charge Indicators. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27
▫ To Unlock The Doors And Liftgate . . . . . . . . . .36
䡵 A WORD ABOUT YOUR KEYS . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
▫ Remote Key Unlock, Driver Door/All Doors
1st Press . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
▫ Ignition Key Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
▫ Locking Doors With A Key. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
▫ Key-In-Ignition Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
䡵 SENTRY KEY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
▫ Replacement Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
䡵 VEHICLE SECURITY ALARM . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
▫ To Arm The System: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
▫ To Disarm The System: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
䡵 REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE) — IF
EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .36
▫ To Lock The Doors And Liftgate . . . . . . . . . . . .37
▫ Transmitter Battery Replacement . . . . . . . . . . .37
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
䡵 DOOR LOCKS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
▫ Power Door Locks — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . .41
▫ Auto Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
䡵 POWER WINDOWS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
▫ Power Window Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
▫ Auto-Down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
▫ Wind Buffeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 11
䡵 LIFTGATE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43 䡵 SAFETY TIPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90
䡵 OCCUPANT RESTRAINT SYSTEMS . . . . . . . . . .44
▫ Transporting Passengers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90
▫ Important Safety Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
▫ Safety Checks You Should Make Inside The
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
▫ Seat Belt Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
▫ Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) . . . . . . . .57
▫ Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71
▫ Periodic Safety Checks You Should Make
Outside The Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93
▫ Transporting Pets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
12 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
IMPORTANT VEHICLE INFORMATION
Your 500e operates entirely on electricity stored in the
high voltage battery. Unlike a conventional vehicle or
Hybrid there is no internal combustion engine. Battery
Electric Vehicles have unique operating characteristics
that you should become familiar with to ensure you are
getting the optimal performance from your vehicle.
High Voltage Battery
Your vehicle is equipped with a Lithium-ion high voltage
battery that is used to power the electric powertrain
systems and the 12 volt vehicle electrical system.
1 — High Voltage Cables
The high voltage battery is located under the vehicle. The 2 — High Voltage Battery
high voltage battery is maintenance free and designed to
last for the life of the vehicle.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 13
Lithium-ion batteries provide the following benefits:
• Lithium-ion batteries are much lighter than other
types of rechargeable batteries of the same size.
• Lithium-ion batteries hold their charge; they only lose
approximately 3 percent of their charge per month.
WARNING!
Never try to remove the high voltage service disconnect. The high voltage service disconnect is used
when your vehicle requires service by a trained
technician at an authorized dealer. Failure to follow
this warning can cause severe burns or electrical
shock that may result in serious injury or death.
• Lithium-ion batteries have no memory, which means
that you do not have to completely discharge them
before recharging, as with some other batteries.
Disposal of the High Voltage Battery
• Lithium-ion batteries can be recharged and discharged Your vehicle’s high voltage battery is designed to last the
thousands of times.
life of your vehicle. See your authorized dealer for
information on the disposal of the battery if it should
High Voltage Battery Service Disconnect
require replacement.
The high voltage battery service disconnect is located
under the rear passenger seat lower cushion. If your General Information
vehicle requires, service see your authorized dealer.
The vehicle is also equipped with a Battery Management
System that is designed to:
• Ensure safe operation
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
14 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
• Maximize driving range
500e ELECTRIC VEHICLE FEATURES
• Maximize the life expectancy of the high voltage Understanding the unique characteristics of your 500e
will help ensure maximum performance and the best
battery
driving range from your vehicle.
NOTE:
Your 500e is equipped with two electrical systems; a 12
• During vehicle start up and shut down a clicking noise Volt system that is used to power the conventional
may be heard from within the vehicle. When the electrical system and a high voltage system, which is
ignition key is turned to the on position, the high used to drive the wheels through a single-speed transvoltage battery contactors inside the battery are closed mission as well as other high voltage system compoto make the stored electricity inside available for nents.
vehicle use. The clicking noise observed is the sound of
these contactors as they open and close and is normal Your 500e operates differently then a traditional vehicle
or Hybrid vehicle. Here are some of the main differences:
operation for your 500e.
• The operating temperature range of the high voltage
battery is -22 °F to 122 °F (-30 °C to 50 °C). If it is
attempted to operate the vehicle with the battery
outside of these temperature extremes it will not
function.
Audible Pedestrian Warning System
Your vehicle is equipped with an Audible Pedestrian
Warning System. The Audible Pedestrian Warning System uses distinct sounds to alert pedestrians that your
vehicle is approaching.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 15
The audible warning system uses an in-car sound synthesizer with a speaker located in the underhood compartment. The warning system is automatically activated
when selecting DRIVE or REVERSE.
Auto Park
Auto Park will automatically place the transmission into
PARK if there is an indication that the driver may leave
the vehicle while still in the DRIVE, NEUTRAL or
In DRIVE range, the system will remain active until the REVERSE gear. Refer to “Single-Speed Transmission” in
vehicle reaches a speed of approximately 22 mph “Starting And Operating” for further information.
(35.5 km/h). At approximately 22 mph (35.5 km/h) the
E-Park
warning system is deactivated and will automatically be
active when the vehicle returns to approximately 20 mph The parking pawl is traditionally located inside an automatic transmission and activated when the vehicle is
(32 km/h).
placed in the PARK position.
Single-Speed Transmission
E-Park is activated when the driver pushes the PARK
Instead of a traditional transmission, your vehicle is
button. An electric motor activates the parking pawl and
equipped with a single-speed transmission to transfer the
locks the single-speed transmission when the vehicle is
torque from the E-Drive motor to the drive wheels. This
placed into PARK. This will prevent any unwanted
transmission requires no maintenance and is designed to
movement of the vehicle.
operate for the life of the vehicle.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
16 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: The engagement of the E-Park can be heard when occupants and the high voltage battery while the vehicle
there is no noise in the interior of the vehicle, this is a is being driven or when it is being charged.
normal condition.
The high voltage battery may require cooling to keep the
vehicle running. The air conditioning compressor will
Climate Control (HVAC System)
activate without any input from the occupant.
Your 500e is equipped with an Automatic Temperature
Control (ATC) HVAC system. This HVAC system utilizes NOTE: The AC system helps cool the high voltage
a humidity sensor, cabin sensor, and ambient tempera- battery. If the air conditioning system should require
ture sensor to choose operation mode and control cabin service see your authorized dealer as soon as possible.
comfort. These components allow the controller to operElectric Power Steering
ate the HVAC system in a very efficient manner to
Your vehicle is equipped with an Electric Power Steering
maximize driving range.
(EPS) system. The power steering system requires no
Your 500e also uses an electric air heater to provide heat
maintenance and operates without the use of power
to the cabin.
steering fluid.
Electric Air Conditioning Compressor
Smartphone Features
Your 500e uses an electric air conditioning compressor.
With the “Uconnect Access” app, you can monitor the
The air conditioning compressor is powered by the high
state of charge of the high voltage battery or initiate
voltage battery system and is used to cool the vehicle
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 17
charging from your phone. You can also turn on your How do I get the “Uconnect Access” smartphone App?
vehicle’s climate control system remotely. The app pro- Visit the 500e registration website:
vides the following features:
www.fiatusa.com/500eRegistration
• Monitor battery charge level
• Display available driving distance
• Check charging status
• Remotely activate vehicle climate control system
• Unlock and lock doors
• Assist with locating your vehicle
• Locate charging stations
• Send a point-of-interest to your vehicle’s navigation
system
• Schedule a charge
• View energy consumed
Registration Website
• Notifications for charging and preconditioning events
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
18 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Once in the registration website, you will need to enter 3. Once finished with registration you will be directed to
your vehicle’s VIN and Connectivity ID. The connectivity
your 500e owner’s site.
ID is found in the vehicle’s instrument cluster. To locate
4. From the 500e owner’s site you will be able to downthe connectivity ID follow the steps below:
load the 500e Uconnect Access mobile application and
1. Push the menu button on the instrument cluster.
learn how to use your connected features.
2. Choose “Settings” and scroll down to the “Connectiv- 5. Use your owner’s site username and password for
logging into the 500e Uconnect Access mobile appliity ID.”
cation.
3. Select “Connectivity ID.”
After obtaining the connectivity ID and VIN number NOTE: Your smartphone must have a valid data connection to use the 500e Uconnect Access mobile application.
return to the vehicle registration website and perform the
following:
Need help with registration?
1. After entering the VIN (Vehicle Identification Num- Please call the Uconnect Call Center Toll Free number below:
ber), Connectivity ID and your email address, click (855) 792-4241
“submit.”
2. You will now be asked to fill in your contact information and a user name and password.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 19
A Level 2 charging station can be installed at your
residence. The Level 2 unit and installation service is
available for purchase at your authorized dealer.
ELECTRIC SYSTEM OPERATION
Level 1 Charging
(120V — Requires NEMA 5–15 Outlet)
Level 1 charging is done by using a conventional 120 Volt
AC grounded receptacle along with the NEMA 5–15
Electric Vehicle Supply Equipment (EVSE) that comes
standard with your vehicle. Refer to “Vehicle Charging
Cord” for further information.
Level 2 Charging
(240V — Requires A 40 Amp Circuit Breaker Or
Greater)
Level 2 charging is accomplished by using 240V permanently mounted EVSEs and is the preferred method for
charging your vehicle.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Level 2 Charging Station
2
20 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Charge Times
The following factors determine the time it takes to
charge the high voltage battery:
• The high voltage battery’s current state of charge
Type of Charge
Level 1 (120V/15A)
Level 2 (240V/30A)
Estimated Charge Time
Approximately 23 hours
Approximately 4 hours
Vehicle Charge Cord
• What level EVSE is being used (Level 1 – 120V or Level
2 – 240V)
• Ambient temperature
Your vehicle comes equipped with a standard AC 120V
NEMA 5-15 Electric Vehicle Supply Equipment (EVSE)
also referred to as a charge cord.
The EVSE plugs into any standard AC grounded outlet
and is used to charge the high voltage battery. To access
• The charging times are estimates based on a com- the charge cord, lift the rear cargo cover and remove the
pletely discharged high voltage battery.
charging cord from the storage bin.
NOTE:
• Charging times will vary based on the age, condition,
state of charge and temperature of the high voltage
battery.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 21
2
EVSE Location
SAE J1772 Charge Receptacle
NOTE: The EVSE charge cord is used for Level 1 NOTE: The charge receptacle door locks and unlocks
charging only.
with the vehicle doors.
SAE J1772 Charge Receptacle
Your vehicle uses an industry standard SAE J1772 charge
receptacle (vehicle’s inlet) for both AC Level 1 (120V) and
AC Level 2 (240V) charging.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
22 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
EVSE Operation And Status Information
Indicator
2 — Fault Indicator
LED
3 — Charge Level
Indicator LED’s
Description
Green indicates READY
RED indicates a fault
All ON indicates system ready
and not charging
LED’s turning on and off in
sequence indicates vehicle
charging
When the EVSE is first plugged in it will go through an
initialization and self test. For the first three seconds after
plugging in your EVSE all the LED’s will remain off.
EVSE Status Indicators
Indicator
1 — AC Indicator
LED
Description
Green indicates READY
RED Indicates a fault
After approximately three seconds the EVSE performs an
internal self test and Ground Continuity Test. This process takes approximately six seconds.
During the internal self test the unit turns on one Charge
Level Indicator LED every 1.5 seconds until all the
Charge Level Indicator LED’s are illuminated.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 23
•
Fault
Indicator LED
•
•
•
AC
LED
Charge Level Indicator
LED’s
•
o
o
o
•
•
o
o
Time
AC LED
1.5
sec
3.0
sec
4.5
sec
6.0
sec
•
Fault
Indicator
LED
•
Charge Level Indicator
LED’s
•
•
•
•
After the EVSE is connected to the vehicle’s charge inlet
the EVSE will continue to illuminate all LED’s green.
Once the vehicle begins charging the EVSE Charge level
LED’s will illuminate in order from left to right, then shut
off. This pattern will repeat as long as the EVSE remains
•
•
•
•
•
•
connected to AC power and the vehicle is actively
charging. Completion of charge will result in illuminatIf the self test is successful the AC LED, the Fault ing all LED’s green. If the vehicle stops charging, the LED
Indicator LED and the four Charge Level LED’s will turn pattern will stop.
solid green.
The LED’s are illuminated and turn off at the rate of one
The EVSE LED’s will be used to indicate the vehicle’s change per second and the battery is charging.
connection status if no faults are found during the self
test.
•
•
•
•
•
o
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
24 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
•
Fault
Indicator LED
•
•
AC
LED
Charging The High Voltage Battery
Charge Level Indicator
LED’s
•
o
o
o
•
•
•
o
o
•
•
•
•
•
o
•
•
•
•
•
•
Time
1.0
sec
2.0
sec
3.0
sec
4.0
sec
1. Put the vehicle in PARK.
2. Turn the ignition to the OFF position.
3. Remove the Level 1 EVSE from its storage bin by
lifting the rear cargo cover.
Refer to the Level 1 User Manual for any additional
information on its use or operation.
EVSE Location
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 25
4. Uncoil the entire length of the EVSE (charge cord).
5. Plug the EVSE into a standard 120V AC outlet that is
properly grounded. It is recommended that the EVSE
is connected to an AC outlet on a circuit which is not
electrically loaded by other devices. Extension cords
may not be used.
2
NOTE: All of the EVSE LED’s illuminate green.
6. Open the charge receptacle door.
NOTE: The charge receptacle door is locked whenever
the vehicle is locked. Unlock the doors to unlock the
charge receptacle door for charging.
7. Plug the EVSE into the charge receptacle. Push the
EVSE in firmly until it is completely engaged (if not
completely engaged the vehicle may not charge).
EVSE Charge Coupler
NOTE:
• The vehicle will initiate the charging cycle automatically when all the conditions are satisfied.
• The vehicle charge indicator will show the pattern
for charging.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
26 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Charge Indicator
Charge Receptacle Door
8. When charging is complete, or the vehicle needs to be NOTE:
unplugged, remove the EVSE by pushing the button
• In the event of an error in the charging process, the AC
on the charge connector and pull firmly to remove it
power to the vehicle will stop and a red indicator will
from the charge receptacle.
illuminate on the EVSE.
9. Close the charge receptacle door.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 27
• Keep the door for the charge receptacle closed when
not in use.
2
Vehicle Charge Indicators
Instrument Cluster High Voltage Battery Gauge
There is a battery gauge indicator located on the instrument cluster. The battery gauge will display, with progressive color indication, the current state of charge for
the high voltage battery; with the percentage value
located at the bottom of the gauge.
High Voltage Battery Gauge
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
28 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Charge Low And Limited Power Messages
The state of charge is monitored during normal operation. If the state of charge reaches certain thresholds the
following messages will also be displayed on the cluster:
• charge low — displayed at 17% (warning displayed for
six seconds).
• charge low — displayed at 11% (Displayed for six
seconds).
Charge Low Message
• charge low limited power mode — turtle displayed at
5% and remains on.
• charge low limited power mode — turtle flashes at 0%
until condition changes.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 29
NOTE: The limited power mode can also be activated if the NOTE: At 0% state of charge or below the following
high voltage battery temperature is too high or too low.
features will be disabled if in use:
• Heated Seats
• Electronic Speed Control
• Climate Controls
Instrument Panel State Of Charge Indicator
In addition to the battery gauge your vehicle is equipped
with a visual state of charge indicator. The state of charge
indicator is made up of five lights that are mounted to the
center of the instrument panel.
Charge Low Limited Power Mode
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
30 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: In the event of an error in the charging process
the outer two lights will blink.
Number Of Indicator
Lights Illuminated
1 Light
2 Lights
3 Lights
4 Lights
5 Lights
State Of Charge Indicator
The state of charge indicator represents the current state
of charge for the high voltage battery. The state of charge
indicator lights quickly to identify the battery state of
charge while the vehicle is being charged. Each light
represents the battery’s current percentage of charge.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Percent Of Battery
Charge
0 – 20%
21 – 40%
41 – 60%
61 – 80%
81 – 100%
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 31
The vehicle is supplied with a code card containing key
The key fob contains the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) code numbers to order duplicate keys, and the authotransmitter with an integrated key. To use the mechanical rized dealer that sold you your new vehicle has the key
code numbers for your vehicle locks. These numbers can
key, simply push the mechanical key release button.
be used to order duplicate keys.
A WORD ABOUT YOUR KEYS
Ignition Key Removal
1. Place the transmission in PARK.
2. Rotate the key to the OFF/LOCK position.
3. Remove the key from the ignition switch lock cylinder.
Mechanical Key Release Button
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
32 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
Ignition Switch Positions
1 — STOP (OFF/LOCK)
2 — MAR (ACC/ON/RUN)
3 — AVV (START)
• Before exiting a vehicle, always apply the parking
brake, place the transmission into PARK, and remove the Key Fob from the ignition. When leaving
the vehicle, always lock your vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle.
• Allowing children to be in a vehicle unattended is
dangerous for a number of reasons. A child or
others could be seriously or fatally injured. Children should be warned not to touch the parking
brake, brake pedal or the transmission gear selector
buttons.
• Do not leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle, or
in a location accessible to children. A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
(Continued)
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 33
Key-In-Ignition Reminder
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not leave children or animals inside parked
vehicles in hot weather. Interior heat build-up may
cause serious injury or death.
Opening the driver’s door when the key is in the ignition
and the ignition switch position is OFF/LOCK sounds a
signal to remove the key.
SENTRY KEY
CAUTION!
An unlocked vehicle is an invitation to thieves.
Always remove the key from the ignition and lock all
the doors when leaving the vehicle unattended.
Locking Doors With A Key
You can insert the key with either side up. To lock the
door, turn the key to the left. To unlock the door, turn the
key to the right. Refer to “Body Lubrication” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for maintenance procedures.
The Sentry Key Immobilizer System prevents unauthorized vehicle operation by disabling the engine. The
system does not need to be armed or activated. Operation
is automatic, regardless of whether the vehicle is locked
or unlocked.
The system uses ignition keys which have an embedded
electronic chip (transponder) to prevent unauthorized
vehicle operation. Therefore, only keys that are programmed to the vehicle can be used to start and operate
the vehicle.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
34 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: A key which has not been programmed is also Replacement Keys
considered an invalid key, even if it is cut to fit the
NOTE: Only keys that have been programmed to the
ignition switch lock cylinder for that vehicle.
vehicle electronics can be used to start the vehicle. Once
If the Vehicle Security Light is on after the key is turned a Sentry Key has been programmed to a vehicle, it cannot
to the ON/RUN position, it indicates that there is a be programmed to any other vehicle. When having the
Sentry Key Immobilizer System serviced, bring all veproblem with the electronics.
hicle keys with you to an authorized dealer.
CAUTION!
• Always remove the Sentry Key from the vehicle
and lock all doors when leaving the vehicle unattended.
• The Sentry Key Immobilizer system is not compatible with some aftermarket remote starting systems. Use of these systems may result in vehicle
starting problems and loss of security protection.
The VIN is required for authorized dealer replacement of
keys. Duplication of keys may be performed at an
authorized dealer.
General Information
The following regulatory statement applies to all Radio
Frequency (RF) devices equipped in this vehicle:
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules and
with Industry Canada license-exempt RSS standard(s).
All of the keys provided with your new vehicle have Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
been programmed to the vehicle electronics.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 35
1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and
To Arm The System:
2. This device must accept any interference received, Push the Key Fob LOCK button.
including interference that may cause undesired op- To Disarm The System:
eration.
Push the Key Fob UNLOCK button or cycle the ignition
NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressly approved to the ON/RUN position.
by the party responsible for compliance could void the
The Vehicle Security Alarm is designed to protect your
user’s authority to operate the equipment.
vehicle. However, you can create conditions where the
VEHICLE SECURITY ALARM
Vehicle Security Alarm will give you a false alarm. If one
The Vehicle Security Alarm monitors the vehicle doors of the previously described arming sequences has ocfor unauthorized entry and the ignition for unauthorized curred, the Vehicle Security Alarm will arm regardless of
operation. If something triggers the alarm, the Vehicle whether you are in the vehicle or not. If you remain in the
Security Alarm will provide the following audible and vehicle and open a door, the alarm will sound. If this
visible signals: the horn will pulse, the park lamps occurs, disarm the Vehicle Security Alarm.
and/or turn signals will flash, and the Vehicle Security
Light in the instrument cluster will flash.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
36 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
If the Vehicle Security Alarm is armed and the battery
becomes disconnected, the Vehicle Security Alarm will
remain armed when the battery is reconnected. The
exterior lights will flash, and the horn will sound. If this
occurs, disarm the Vehicle Security Alarm.
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE) — IF
EQUIPPED
This system allows you to lock or unlock the doors and
liftgate from distances up to approximately 66 ft (20 m)
using a hand-held Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter. The RKE transmitter does not need to be pointed at
the vehicle to activate the system.
Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter
NOTE: The line of transmission must not be blocked
with metal objects.
To Unlock The Doors And Liftgate
Push and release the UNLOCK button on the RKE
transmitter once to unlock the driver’s door or twice,
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 37
within five seconds, to unlock all doors and the liftgate. The recommended replacement battery is CR2032.
The turn signal lights will flash to acknowledge the
1. Push the mechanical key release button and release the
unlock signal. The illuminated entry system will also
mechanical key to access the battery case screw loturn on.
cated on the side of the Key Fob.
Remote Key Unlock, Driver Door/All Doors 1st
Press
This feature lets you program the system to unlock either
the driver’s door or all doors on the first press of the
UNLOCK button on the RKE transmitter.
To Lock The Doors And Liftgate
Push and release the LOCK button on the RKE transmitter to lock all doors and the liftgate. The turn signal lights
will flash and the horn will chirp to acknowledge the
signal.
Transmitter Battery Replacement
Mechanical Key Release Button
NOTE: Perchlorate Material – special handling may ap- 2. Rotate the screw located on the side of the Key Fob
using a small screwdriver.
ply. See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
38 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Key Fob Screw Location
Battery Case Removed
3. Take out the battery case. Remove and replace the 4. Refit the battery case inside the Key Fob and turn the
battery observing its polarity.
screw to lock it into place.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 39
General Information
DOOR LOCKS
The following regulatory statement applies to all Radio The door locks can be manually locked or unlocked from
inside the vehicle by using the door handle. If the door
Frequency (RF) devices equipped in this vehicle:
handle is pushed a red lock indicator will show on the
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules and door handle (indicating locked) when the door is open or
with Industry Canada license-exempt RSS standard(s). closed, the door will lock.
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
1. This device may not cause harmful interference, and
2. This device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.
NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressly approved
by the party responsible for compliance could void the
user’s authority to operate the equipment.
Door Lock Handle
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
40 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not leave children or animals inside parked
vehicles in hot weather. Interior heat build-up may
cause serious injury or death.
• For personal security and safety in the event of an
collision, lock the vehicle doors as you drive as
well as when you park and leave the vehicle.
• Before exiting a vehicle, always apply the parking
brake, place the transmission into PARK, and remove the Key Fob from the ignition. When leaving
the vehicle, always lock your vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle.
• Allowing children to be in a vehicle unattended is
dangerous for a number of reasons. A child or
others could be seriously or fatally injured. Children should be warned not to touch the parking
brake, brake pedal or the transmission gear selector
buttons.
• Do not leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle, or
in a location accessible to children. A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
(Continued)
An unlocked vehicle is an invitation to thieves.
Always remove the key from the ignition and lock all
of the doors when leaving the vehicle unattended.
CAUTION!
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 41
Power Door Locks — If Equipped
A power door lock switch is incorporated into the driver
door handle. Push or pull the handle to lock or unlock the
doors and liftgate. If the driver’s door handle is pushed
a red lock indicator will show on the driver’s door handle
(indicating locked) when the door is closed, the door will
lock.
2
NOTE: To prevent the key from being locked in the
vehicle, the doors will automatically unlock if the driver’s door handle is pushed when the key is in the
ignition.
Driver’s Power Door Lock Handle
Auto Door Locks
When enabled, the door locks will lock automatically
when the vehicles speed exceeds 12 mph (20 km/h).
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
42 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
To change the setting proceed as follows:
POWER WINDOWS
1. Briefly push the MENU button to enter the MENU Power Window Switches
screen.
There are single window controls located on the shifter
or DOWN
button to highlight bezel, below the climate controls, which operate the
2. Push the UP
“Auto Door Locks”. Push the MENU button, use driver and passenger door windows. The window conor DOWN
buttons to turn setting ON trols will operate when the ignition switch is in the
the UP
ON/RUN position.
or OFF.
3. Briefly push the MENU button to go back to the menu
screen, or push and hold the MENU button (approximately one second) to go back to the main screen
without storing the settings.
NOTE: Use the Automatic Door Locks feature in accordance with local laws.
Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)”
in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” in your Owner’s Manual on your DVD for further information.
WARNING!
Never leave children unattended in a vehicle, and do
not let children play with power windows. Do not
leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle, or in a
location accessible to children. Occupants, particularly unattended children, can become entrapped by
the windows while operating the power window
switches. Such entrapment may result in serious
injury or death.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 43
Wind Buffeting
Wind buffeting can be described as the perception of
pressure on the ears or a helicopter-type sound in the
ears. Your vehicle may exhibit wind buffeting with the
windows down, or the sunroof (if equipped) in certain
open or partially open positions. This is a normal occurrence and can be minimized. If the buffeting occurs with
the sunroof open, adjust the sunroof opening to minimize
the buffeting or open any window.
LIFTGATE
Power Window Switches
Auto-Down
To unlock the liftgate, use the Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) transmitter or activate the power door lock
switches located on the front door handles.
The driver’s door window switch has an Auto-Down feature. Push the window switch for approximately one second, To open the liftgate, squeeze the liftgate release handle
release, and the window will go down automatically. To and pull the liftgate open with one fluid motion.
cancel the Auto-Down movement, operate the switch in
either the up or down direction and release the switch.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
44 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
OCCUPANT RESTRAINT SYSTEMS
Some of the most important safety features in your
vehicle are the restraint systems:
• Seat Belt Systems
• Supplemental Restraint Systems (SRS) Air Bags
• Child Restraints
Important Safety Precautions
Please pay close attention to the information in this
section. It tells you how to use your restraint system
properly, to keep you and your passengers as safe as
Liftgate Handle
Gas props support the liftgate in the open position. possible.
However, because the gas pressure drops with tempera- Here are some simple steps you can take to minimize the
ture, it may be necessary to assist the props when risk of harm from a deploying air bag:
opening the liftgate in cold weather.
1. Children 12 years old and under should always ride
buckled up in a vehicle with a rear seat.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 45
2. If a child from 2 to 12 years old (not in a rear-facing 6. All occupants should always wear their lap and
child restraint) must ride in the front passenger seat,
shoulder belts properly.
move the seat as far back as possible and use the
7. The driver and front passenger seats should be moved
proper child restraint. (Refer to “Child Restraints”)
back as far as practical to allow the Advanced Front
3. Children that are not big enough to wear the vehicle
Air Bags room to inflate.
seat belt properly (Refer to ⬙Child Restraints⬙) should
8. Do not lean against the door or window. If your
be secured in a vehicle with a rear seat in child
vehicle has side air bags, and deployment occurs, the
restraints or belt-positioning booster seats. Older chilside air bags will inflate forcefully into the space
dren who do not use child restraints or beltbetween occupants and the door and occupants could
positioning booster seats should ride properly buckled
be injured.
up in a vehicle with a rear seat.
9. If the air bag system in this vehicle needs to be
4. Never allow children to slide the shoulder belt behind
modified to accommodate a disabled person, contact
them or under their arm.
the Customer Center. Phone numbers are provided
5. You should read the instructions provided with your
under ⬙If You Need Assistance.⬙
child restraint to make sure that you are using it
properly.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
46 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
• Never place a rear-facing child restraint in front of
an air bag. A deploying passenger Advanced Front
Air Bag can cause death or serious injury to a child
12 years or younger, including a child in a rearfacing child restraint.
• Only use a rear-facing child restraint in a vehicle
with a rear seat.
Seat Belt Systems
ejection and the risk of injury caused by striking the
inside of the vehicle. Everyone in a motor vehicle should
be belted at all times.
Driver And Passenger BeltAlert (If Equipped)
BeltAlert is a feature intended to remind the driver
and outboard front seat passenger (if equipped with
outboard front passenger seat BeltAlert) to buckle
their seat belts. The Belt Alert feature is active whenever the ignition switch is in the AVV/START position.
Buckle up even though you are an excellent driver, even Initial Indication
on short trips. Someone on the road may be a poor driver
and could cause a collision that includes you. This can If the driver is unbuckled when the ignition switch is first
turned to the AVV/START position, an intermittent
happen far away from home or on your own street.
chime will signal for a few seconds. If the driver or
Research has shown that seat belts save lives, and they outboard front seat passenger (if equipped with outboard
can reduce the seriousness of injuries in a collision. Some front passenger seat BeltAlert) is unbuckled when the
of the worst injuries happen when people are thrown ignition switch is first turned to the AVV/START position
from the vehicle. Seat belts reduce the possibility of
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 47
the Seat Belt Reminder Light will turn on and remain on Change Of Status
until both outboard front seat belts are buckled. The
If the driver or outboard front seat passenger (if
outboard front passenger seat BeltAlert is not active
equipped with outboard front passenger seat BeltAlert)
when an outboard front passenger seat is unoccupied.
unbuckles their seat belt while the vehicle is traveling,
the BeltAlert warning sequence will begin until the seat
BeltAlert Warning Sequence
belts are buckled again.
The BeltAlert warning sequence is activated when the
vehicle is moving above a specified vehicle speed range The outboard front passenger seat BeltAlert is not active
and the driver or outboard front seat passenger is un- when the outboard front passenger seat is unoccupied.
buckled (if equipped with outboard front passenger seat BeltAlert may be triggered when an animal or heavy
BeltAlert). The BeltAlert warning sequence starts by object is on the outboard front passenger seat or when the
blinking the Seat Belt Reminder Light and sounding an seat is folded flat (if equipped). It is recommended that
intermittent chime. Once the BeltAlert warning sequence pets be restrained in the rear seat (if equipped) in pet
has completed, the Seat Belt Reminder Light will remain harnesses or pet carriers that are secured by seat belts,
on until the seat belts are buckled. The BeltAlert warning and cargo is properly stowed.
sequence may repeat based on vehicle speed until the
BeltAlert can be activated or deactivated by your authodriver and occupied outboard front seat passenger seat
rized dealer. FCA US LLC does not recommend deactibelts are buckled. The driver should instruct all occuvating BeltAlert.
pants to buckle their seat belts.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
48 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: If BeltAlert has been deactivated and the driver
or outboard front seat passenger (if equipped with outboard front passenger seat BeltAlert) is unbuckled the
Seat Belt Reminder Light will turn on and remain on until
the driver and outboard front seat passenger seat belts
are buckled.
Lap/Shoulder Belts
All seating positions in your vehicle are equipped with
lap/shoulder belts.
The seat belt webbing retractor will lock only during very
sudden stops or collisions. This feature allows the shoulder part of the seat belt to move freely with you under
normal conditions. However, in a collision the seat belt
will lock and reduce your risk of striking the inside of the
vehicle or being thrown out of the vehicle.
WARNING!
• Relying on the air bags alone could lead to more
severe injuries in a collision. The air bags work
with your seat belt to restrain you properly. In
some collisions, the air bags won’t deploy at all.
Always wear your seat belt even though you have
air bags.
• In a collision, you and your passengers can suffer
much greater injuries if you are not properly buckled up. You can strike the interior of your vehicle or
other passengers, or you can be thrown out of the
vehicle. Always be sure you and others in your
vehicle are buckled up properly.
• It is dangerous to ride in a cargo area, inside or
outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in
these areas are more likely to be seriously injured
or killed.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
(Continued)
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 49
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not allow people to ride in any area of your
vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat
belts.
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
using a seat belt properly.
• Wearing your seat belt incorrectly could make your
injuries in a collision much worse. You might
suffer internal injuries, or you could even slide out
of the seat belt. Follow these instructions to wear
your seat belt safely and to keep your passengers
safe, too.
• Two people should never be belted into a single
seat belt. People belted together can crash into one
another in a collision, hurting one another badly.
Never use a lap/shoulder belt or a lap belt for more
than one person, no matter what their size.
• A lap belt worn too high can increase the risk of
injury in a collision. The seat belt forces won’t be at
the strong hip and pelvic bones, but across your
abdomen. Always wear the lap part of your seat
belt as low as possible and keep it snug.
• A twisted seat belt may not protect you properly. In
a collision, it could even cut into you. Be sure the
seat belt is flat against your body, without twists. If
you can’t straighten a seat belt in your vehicle, take
it to your authorized dealer immediately and have
it fixed.
• A seat belt that is buckled into the wrong buckle
will not protect you properly. The lap portion could
ride too high on your body, possibly causing internal injuries. Always buckle your seat belt into the
buckle nearest you.
(Continued)
(Continued)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
50 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• A seat belt that is too loose will not protect you
properly. In a sudden stop, you could move too far
forward, increasing the possibility of injury. Wear
your seat belt snugly.
• A seat belt that is worn under your arm is dangerous.
Your body could strike the inside surfaces of the
vehicle in a collision, increasing head and neck
injury. A seat belt worn under the arm can cause
internal injuries. Ribs aren’t as strong as shoulder
bones. Wear the seat belt over your shoulder so that
your strongest bones will take the force in a collision.
• A shoulder belt placed behind you will not protect
you from injury during a collision. You are more
likely to hit your head in a collision if you do not
wear your shoulder belt. The lap and shoulder belt
are meant to be used together.
• A frayed or torn seat belt could rip apart in a
collision and leave you with no protection. Inspect
the seat belt system periodically, checking for cuts,
frays, or loose parts. Damaged parts must be replaced immediately. Do not disassemble or modify
the seat belt system. Seat belt assemblies must be
replaced after a collision.
(Continued)
Lap/Shoulder Belt Operating Instructions
1. Enter the vehicle and close the door. Sit back and
adjust the seat.
2. The seat belt latch plate is above the back of the front
seat, and next to your arm in the rear seat (for vehicles
equipped with a rear seat). Grasp the latch plate and
pull out the seat belt. Slide the latch plate up the
webbing as far as necessary to allow the seat belt to go
around your lap.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 51
2
Pulling Out The Latch Plate
Inserting Latch Plate Into Buckle
3. When the seat belt is long enough to fit, insert the latch 4. Position the lap belt so that it is snug and lies low
plate into the buckle until you hear a “click.”
across your hips, below your abdomen. To remove
slack in the lap belt portion, pull up on the shoulder
belt. To loosen the lap belt if it is too tight, tilt the latch
plate and pull on the lap belt. A snug seat belt reduces
the risk of sliding under the seat belt in a collision.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
52 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
6. To release the seat belt, push the red button on the
buckle. The seat belt will automatically retract to its
stowed position. If necessary, slide the latch plate
down the webbing to allow the seat belt to retract
fully.
Lap/Shoulder Belt Untwisting Procedure
Use the following procedure to untwist a twisted lap/
shoulder belt.
1. Position the latch plate as close as possible to the
anchor point.
Positioning The Lap Belt
5. Position the shoulder belt across the shoulder and
chest with minimal, if any slack so that it is comfortable and not resting on your neck. The retractor will
withdraw any slack in the shoulder belt.
2. At about 6 to 12 in (15 to 30 cm) above the latch plate,
grasp and twist the seat belt webbing 180 degrees to
create a fold that begins immediately above the latch
plate.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 53
3. Slide the latch plate upward over the folded webbing.
The folded webbing must enter the slot at the top of
the latch plate.
4. Continue to slide the latch plate up until it clears the
folded webbing and the seat belt is no longer twisted.
Seat Belt Extender
If a seat belt is not long enough to fit properly, even when
the webbing is fully extended and the adjustable upper
shoulder belt anchorage (if equipped) is in its lowest
position, your authorized dealer can provide you with a
Seat Belt Extender. The Seat Belt Extender should be used
only if the existing seat belt is not long enough. When the
Seat Belt Extender is not required for a different occupant, it must be removed.
WARNING!
• ONLY use a Seat Belt Extender if it is physically
required in order to properly fit the original seat
belt system. DO NOT USE the Seat Belt Extender
if, when worn, the distance between the front edge
of the Seat Belt Extender buckle and the center of
the occupant’s body is LESS than 6 inches.
• Using a Seat Belt Extender when not needed can
increase the risk of serious injury or death in a
collision. Only use the Seat Belt Extender when the
lap belt is not long enough and only use in the
recommended seating positions. Remove and store
the Seat Belt Extender when not needed.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
54 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Seat Belts And Pregnant Women
Position the lap belt snug and low below the abdomen
and across the strong bones of the hips. Place the
shoulder belt across the chest and away from the neck.
Never place the shoulder belt behind the back or under
the arm.
Seat Belt Pretensioner
The front seat belt system is equipped with pretensioning
devices that are designed to remove slack from the seat
belt in the event of a collision. These devices may
improve the performance of the seat belt by removing
slack from the seat belt early in a collision. Pretensioners
work for all size occupants, including those in child
restraints.
Pregnant Women And Seat Belts
NOTE: These devices are not a substitute for proper seat
Seat belts must be worn by all occupants including belt placement by the occupant. The seat belt still must be
pregnant women: the risk of injury in the event of an worn snugly and positioned properly.
accident is reduced for the mother and the unborn child
if they are wearing a seat belt.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 55
The pretensioners are triggered by the Occupant Re- Restraints” section of this manual. The table below
straint Controller (ORC). Like the air bags, the preten- defines the type of feature for each seating position.
sioners are single use items. A deployed pretensioner or
a deployed air bag must be replaced immediately.
Energy Management Feature
This vehicle has a seat belt system with an Energy
Management feature in the front seating positions that
may help further reduce the risk of injury in the event of
a collision. This seat belt system has a retractor assembly
that is designed to release webbing in a controlled
manner.
Switchable Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)
The seat belts in the passenger seating positions are
equipped with a Switchable Automatic Locking Retractor
(ALR) which is used to secure a child restraint system.
For additional information, refer to “Installing Child • ALR — Switchable Automatic Locking Retractor
Restraints Using The Vehicle Seat Belt” under the “Child
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
56 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
If the passenger seating position is equipped with an
ALR and is being used for normal usage, only pull the
seat belt webbing out far enough to comfortably wrap
around the occupant’s mid-section so as to not activate
the ALR. If the ALR is activated, you will hear a clicking
sound as the seat belt retracts. Allow the webbing to
retract completely in this case and then carefully pull out
only the amount of webbing necessary to comfortably
wrap around the occupant’s mid-section. Slide the latch
plate into the buckle until you hear a ⬙click.⬙
WARNING!
• Never place a rear-facing child restraint in front of
an air bag. A deploying Passenger Advanced Front
Air Bag can cause death or serious injury to a child
12 years or younger, including a child in a rearfacing child restraint.
• Only use a rear-facing child restraint in a vehicle
with a rear seat.
How To Engage The Automatic Locking Mode
In Automatic Locking Mode, the shoulder belt is automatically pre-locked. The seat belt will still retract to 1. Buckle the combination lap and shoulder belt.
remove any slack in the shoulder belt. Use the Automatic 2. Grasp the shoulder portion and pull downward until
Locking Mode anytime a child restraint is installed in a
the entire seat belt is extracted.
seating position that has a seat belt with this feature.
Children 12 years old and under should always be 3. Allow the seat belt to retract. As the seat belt retracts,
you will hear a clicking sound. This indicates the seat
properly restrained in a vehicle with a rear seat.
belt is now in the Automatic Locking Mode.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 57
How To Disengage The Automatic Locking Mode
Unbuckle the combination lap/shoulder belt and allow it
to retract completely to disengage the Automatic Locking
Mode and activate the vehicle sensitive (emergency)
locking mode.
WARNING! (Continued)
only used to install rear-facing or forward-facing
child restraints that have a harness for restraining
the child.
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
WARNING!
Air Bag System Components
• The seat belt assembly must be replaced if the
switchable Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) feature or any other seat belt function is not working
properly when checked according to the procedures in the Service Manual.
• Failure to replace the seat belt assembly could
increase the risk of injury in collisions.
• Do not use the Automatic Locking Mode to restrain
occupants who are wearing the seat belt or children
who are using booster seats. The locked mode is
Your vehicle may be equipped with the following air bag
system components:
• Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC)
• Air Bag Warning Light
• Steering Wheel and Column
• Instrument Panel
• Knee Impact Bolsters
• Advanced Front Air Bags
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
(Continued)
2
58 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
• Supplemental Side Air Bags
• Supplemental Knee Air Bags
• Front and Side Impact Sensors
• Seat Belt Pretensioners
• Seat Belt Buckle Switch
• Seat Track Position Sensors
Advanced Front Air Bags
This vehicle has Advanced Front Air Bags for both the
driver and front passenger as a supplement to the seat
Advanced Front Air Bag And Knee Bolster Locations
belt restraint systems. The driver’s Advanced Front Air
Bag is mounted in the center of the steering wheel. The 1 — Driver And Passenger Advanced Front Air Bags
passenger’s Advanced Front Air Bag is mounted in the 2 — Passenger Knee Impact Bolster
3 — Driver Knee Impact Bolster/Supplemental Driver Knee Air Bag
instrument panel, above the glove compartment. The
words “SRS AIRBAG” or “AIRBAG” are embossed on
the air bag covers.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 59
Advanced Front Air Bag Features
WARNING!
• Being too close to the steering wheel or instrument
panel during Advanced Front Air Bag deployment
could cause serious injury, including death. Air
bags need room to inflate. Sit back, comfortably
extending your arms to reach the steering wheel or
instrument panel.
• Never place a rear-facing child restraint in front of
an air bag. A deploying Passenger Advanced Front
Air Bag can cause death or serious injury to a child
12 years or younger, including a child in a rearfacing child restraint.
• Only use a rear-facing child restraint in a vehicle
with a rear seat.
The Advanced Front Air Bag system has multistage
driver and front passenger air bags. This system provides
output appropriate to the severity and type of collision as
determined by the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC),
which may receive information from the front impact
sensors or other system components.
The first stage inflator is triggered immediately during an
impact that requires air bag deployment. A low energy
output is used in less severe collisions. A higher energy
output is used for more severe collisions.
This vehicle may be equipped with a driver and/or front
passenger seat belt buckle switch that detects whether
the driver or front passenger seat belt is buckled. The seat
belt buckle switch may adjust the inflation rate of the
Advanced Front Air Bags.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
60 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Advanced Front Air Bag Operation
WARNING!
• No objects should be placed over or near the air
bag on the instrument panel or steering wheel,
because any such objects could cause harm if the
vehicle is in a collision severe enough to cause the
air bags to inflate.
• Do not put anything on or around the air bag
covers or attempt to open them manually. You may
damage the air bags and you could be injured
because the air bags may no longer be functional.
The protective covers for the air bag cushions are
designed to open only when the air bags are
inflating.
• Relying on the air bags alone could lead to more
severe injuries in a collision. The air bags work with
your seat belt to restrain you properly. In some
collisions, air bags won’t deploy at all. Always wear
your seat belts even though you have air bags.
Advanced Front Air Bags are designed to provide additional protection by supplementing the seat belts. Advanced Front Air Bags are not expected to reduce the risk
of injury in rear, side, or rollover collisions. The Advanced Front Air Bags will not deploy in all frontal
collisions, including some that may produce substantial
vehicle damage — for example, some pole collisions,
truck underrides, and angle offset collisions.
On the other hand, depending on the type and location of
impact, Advanced Front Air Bags may deploy in crashes
with little vehicle front-end damage but that produce a
severe initial deceleration.
Because air bag sensors measure vehicle deceleration
over time, vehicle speed and damage by themselves are
not good indicators of whether or not an air bag should
have deployed.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 61
Seat belts are necessary for your protection in all colli- Knee Impact Bolsters
sions, and also are needed to help keep you in position, The Knee Impact Bolsters help protect the knees of the
away from an inflating air bag.
driver and front passenger, and position the front occuWhen the ORC detects a collision requiring the Ad- pants for improved interaction with the Advanced Front
vanced Front Air Bags, it signals the inflator units. A large Air Bags.
quantity of non-toxic gas is generated to inflate the
WARNING!
Advanced Front Air Bags.
The steering wheel hub trim cover and the upper right
side of the instrument panel separate and fold out of the
way as the air bags inflate to their full size. The Advanced
Front Air Bags fully inflate in less time than it takes to
blink your eyes. The air bags then quickly deflate while
helping to restrain the driver and front passenger.
• Do not drill, cut, or tamper with the knee impact
bolsters in any way.
• Do not mount any accessories to the knee impact
bolsters such as alarm lights, stereos, citizen band
radios, etc.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
62 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Supplemental Driver Knee Air Bag
This vehicle is equipped with a Supplemental Driver
Knee Air Bag mounted in the instrument panel below the
steering column. The Supplemental Driver Knee Air Bag
provides enhanced protection during a frontal impact by
working together with the seat belts, pretensioners, and
Advanced Front Air Bags.
Supplemental Side Air Bags
Your vehicle is equipped with two types of supplemental
Side Air Bags:
1. Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bags (SABs):
Supplemental Seat-Mounted Side Air Bag Label
Located in the outboard side of the front seats. The The SABs may help to reduce the risk of occupant injury
SABs are marked with a “SRS AIRBAG” or AIRBAG during certain side impacts, in addition to the injury
label sewn into the outboard side of the seats.
reduction potential provided by the seat belts and body
structure.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 63
When the SAB deploys, it opens the seam on the outboard
side of the seatback’s trim cover. The inflating SAB deploys
through the seat seam into the space between the occupant
and the door. The SAB moves at a very high speed and
with such a high force that it could injure occupants if they
are not seated properly, or if items are positioned in the
area where the SAB inflates. Children are at an even greater
risk of injury from a deploying air bag.
2
WARNING!
Do not use accessory seat covers or place objects
between you and the Side Air Bags; the performance
could be adversely affected and/or objects could be
pushed into you, causing serious injury.
Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtain (SABIC)
Label Location
SABICs may help reduce the risk of head and other
injuries to front and rear seat outboard occupants in
2. Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtains
certain side impacts in addition to the injury reduction
(SABICs): Located above the side windows. The trim
potential provided by the seat belts and body structure.
covering the SABICs is labeled “SRS AIRBAG” or
“AIRBAG.”
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
64 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
The SABIC deploys downward, covering the side windows. An inflating SABIC pushes the outside edge of
the headliner out of the way and covers the window.
The SABICs inflate with enough force to injure occupants if they are not belted and seated properly, or if
items are positioned in the area where the SABICs
inflate. Children are at an even greater risk of injury
from a deploying air bag.
The SABICs may help reduce the risk of partial or
complete ejection of vehicle occupants through side
windows in certain side impact events.
WARNING!
• Your vehicle is equipped with left and right Supplemental Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtains (SABICs).
Do not stack luggage or other cargo up high enough
to block the deployment of the SABICs. The trim
covering above the side windows where the SABIC
and its deployment path are located should remain
free from any obstructions.
• Your vehicle is equipped with SABICs. In order for
the SABICs to work as intended, do not install any
accessory items in your vehicle which could alter
the roof. Do not add an aftermarket sunroof to your
vehicle. Do not add roof racks that require permanent attachments (bolts or screws) for installation
on the vehicle roof. Do not drill into the roof of the
vehicle for any reason.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 65
The SABICs and SABs (“Side Air Bags”) are designed to
activate in certain side impacts. The Occupant Restraint
Controller (“ORC”) determines whether the deployment
of the Side Air Bags in a particular impact event is
appropriate, based on the severity and type of collision.
The side impact sensors aid the ORC in determining the
appropriate response to impact events. The system is
calibrated to deploy the Side Air Bags on the impact side
of the vehicle during impacts that require Side Air Bag
occupant protection. In side impacts, the Side Air Bags
deploy independently; a left side impact deploys the left
Side Air Bags only and a right-side impact deploys the
right Side Air Bags only. Vehicle damage by itself is not a
good indicator of whether or not Side Air Bags should
have deployed.
compartment. The Side Air Bags may deploy during
angled or offset frontal collisions where the Advanced
Front Air Bags deploy.
Side Air Bags are a supplement to the seat belt restraint
system. Side Air Bags deploy in less time than it takes to
blink your eyes. Occupants, including children, who are
up against or very close to Side Air Bags can be seriously
injured or killed. Occupants, including children, should
never lean on or sleep against the door, side windows, or
area where the Side Air Bags inflate, even if they are in an
infant or child restraint.
Seat belts (and child restraints where appropriate) are
necessary for your protection in all collisions. They also
help keep you in position, away from inflating Side Air
Bags. To get the best protection from the Side Air Bags,
The Side Air Bags will not deploy in all side collisions,
occupants must wear their seat belts properly and sit
including some collisions at certain angles, or some side
upright with their backs against the seats. Children must
collisions that do not impact the area of the passenger
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
66 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
be properly restrained in a child restraint or booster seat If A Deployment Occurs
that is appropriate for the size of the child.
The Advanced Front Air Bags are designed to deflate
immediately after deployment.
WARNING!
• Side Air Bags need room to inflate. Do not lean
against the door or window. Sit upright in the
center of the seat.
• Being too close to the Side Air Bags during deployment could cause you to be severely injured or
killed.
• Relying on the Side Air Bags alone could lead to
more severe injuries in a collision. The Side Air
Bags work with your seat belt to restrain you
properly. In some collisions, Side Air Bags won’t
deploy at all. Always wear your seat belt even
though you have Side Air Bags.
NOTE: Front and/or side air bags will not deploy in all
collisions. This does not mean something is wrong with
the air bag system.
If you do have a collision which deploys the air bags, any
or all of the following may occur:
• The air bag material may sometimes cause abrasions
and/or skin reddening to the occupants as the air bags
deploy and unfold. The abrasions are similar to friction rope burns or those you might get sliding along a
carpet or gymnasium floor. They are not caused by
contact with chemicals. They are not permanent and
normally heal quickly. However, if you haven’t healed
significantly within a few days, or if you have any
NOTE: Air bag covers may not be obvious in the interior
blistering, see your doctor immediately.
trim, but they will open during air bag deployment.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 67
• As the air bags deflate, you may see some smoke-like
WARNING! (Continued)
particles. The particles are a normal by-product of the
process that generates the non-toxic gas used for air seat belt pretensioners, and the seat belt retractor
bag inflation. These airborne particles may irritate the assemblies replaced by an authorized dealer immeskin, eyes, nose, or throat. If you have skin or eye diately. Also, have the Occupant Restraint Controller
irritation, rinse the area with cool water. For nose or System serviced as well.
throat irritation, move to fresh air. If the irritation
NOTE:
continues, see your doctor. If these particles settle on
your clothing, follow the garment manufacturer’s in- • Air bag covers may not be obvious in the interior trim,
structions for cleaning.
but they will open during air bag deployment.
Do not drive your vehicle after the air bags have de- • After any collision, the vehicle should be taken to an
ployed. If you are involved in another collision, the air
authorized dealer immediately.
bags will not be in place to protect you.
Enhanced Accident Response System
WARNING!
Deployed air bags and seat belt pretensioners cannot
protect you in another collision. Have the air bags,
In the event of an impact, if the communication network
remains intact, and the power remains intact, depending
on the nature of the event, the ORC will determine
whether to have the Enhanced Accident Response System perform the following functions:
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
(Continued)
2
68 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
• Cut off battery power to the motor.
Air Bag Warning Light
• Flash hazard lights as long as the battery has power or The air bags must be ready to inflate for your protection
in a collision. The Occupant Restraint Controluntil the hazard light button is pressed. The hazard
ler (ORC) monitors the internal circuits and
lights can be deactivated by pressing the hazard light
interconnecting wiring associated with air bag
button.
system electrical components.
• Turn on the interior lights, which remain on as long as
The ORC monitors the readiness of the electronic parts of
the battery has power.
the air bag system whenever the ignition switch is in the
• Unlock the power door locks.
AVV/START or MAR position. If the ignition switch is in
the STOP position the air bag system is not on and the air
Enhanced Accident Response System Reset
bags will not inflate.
Procedure
After an event occurs requiring activation of the Enhanced Accident Response System, when the system is
active, a “Service EV System” message” will be displayed
on the instrument cluster. The vehicle is not drivable in
this state and must be towed to an authorized dealer
immediately to be inspected and have the Enhanced
Accident Response System reset.
The ORC contains a backup power supply system that
may deploy the air bags even if the battery loses power or
it becomes disconnected prior to deployment.
The ORC turns on the Air Bag Warning Light in the
instrument panel for approximately four to eight seconds
for a self-check when the ignition switch is first turned to
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 69
the MAR position. After the self-check, the Air Bag
Warning Light will turn off. If the ORC detects a malfunction in any part of the system, it turns on the Air Bag
Warning Light, either momentarily or continuously. A
single chime will sound to alert you if the light comes on
again after initial startup.
• The Air Bag Warning Light comes on intermittently or
remains on while driving.
NOTE: If the speedometer, tachometer, or any engine
related gauges are not working, the Occupant Restraint
Controller (ORC) may also be disabled. In this condition
the air bags may not be ready to inflate for your protecThe ORC also includes diagnostics that will illuminate tion. Have an authorized dealer service the air bag
the instrument panel Air Bag Warning Light if a malfunc- system immediately.
tion is detected that could affect the air bag system. The
diagnostics also record the nature of the malfunction.
WARNING!
While the air bag system is designed to be maintenance
free, if any of the following occurs, have an authorized Ignoring the Air Bag Warning Light in your instrument panel could mean you won’t have the air bags to
dealer service the air bag system immediately.
protect you in a collision. If the light does not come on
• The Air Bag Warning Light does not come on during as a bulb check when the ignition is first placed in the
the four to eight seconds when the ignition switch is on position, and stays on after you start the vehicle, or
first turned to the MAR position.
if it comes on as you drive, have an authorized dealer
• The Air Bag Warning Light remains on after the four to service the air bag system immediately.
eight-second interval.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
70 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Maintaining Your Air Bag System
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING!
• Modifications to any part of the air bag system
could cause it to fail when you need it. You could
be injured if the air bag system is not there to
protect you. Do not modify the components or
wiring, including adding any kind of badges or
stickers to the steering wheel hub trim cover or the
upper right side of the instrument panel. Do not
modify the front bumper, vehicle body structure, or
add aftermarket side steps or running boards.
• It is dangerous to try to repair any part of the air
bag system yourself. Be sure to tell anyone who
works on your vehicle that it has an air bag system.
• Do not attempt to modify any part of your air bag
system. The air bag may inflate accidentally or may
(Continued)
not function properly if modifications are made.
Take your vehicle to an authorized dealer for any
air bag system service. If your seat, including your
trim cover and cushion, needs to be serviced in any
way (including removal or loosening/tightening of
seat attachment bolts), take the vehicle to your
authorized dealer. Only manufacturer approved
seat accessories may be used. If it is necessary to
modify the air bag system for persons with disabilities, contact your authorized dealer.
Event Data Recorder (EDR)
This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder
(EDR). The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in
certain crash or near crash-like situations, such as an air
bag deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data that will
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 71
assist in understanding how a vehicle’s systems performed. The EDR is designed to record data related to
vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of
time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this vehicle
is designed to record such data as:
NOTE: EDR data are recorded by your vehicle only if a
non-trivial crash situation occurs; no data are recorded by
the EDR under normal driving conditions and no personal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and crash location)
are recorded. However, other parties, such as law enforcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of
• How various systems in your vehicle were operating;
personally identifying data routinely acquired during a
• Whether or not the driver and passenger safety belts crash investigation.
were buckled/fastened;
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is
• How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the required, and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed.
accelerator and/or brake pedal; and,
In addition to the vehicle manufacturer, other parties,
such as law enforcement, that have the special equip• How fast the vehicle was traveling.
ment, can read the information if they have access to the
These data can help provide a better understanding of vehicle or the EDR.
the circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur.
Child Restraints
Everyone in your vehicle needs to be buckled up at all
times, including babies and children.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
72 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Every state in the United States, and every Canadian
province, requires that small children ride in proper
restraint systems. This is the law, and you can be prosecuted for ignoring it.
There are different sizes and types of restraints for children
from newborn size to the child almost large enough for an
adult safety belt. Always check the child seat Owner’s
Manual to make sure you have the correct seat for your
Children 12 years or younger should ride properly child. Carefully read and follow all the instructions and
warnings in the child restraint Owner’s Manual and on all
buckled up in a rear seat, if available. According to crash
statistics, children are safer when properly restrained in the labels attached to the child restraint.
Before buying any restraint system, make sure that it has
the rear seats rather than in the front.
a label certifying that it meets all applicable Safety
Standards. You should also make sure that you can install
WARNING!
it in the vehicle where you will use it.
In a collision, an unrestrained child can become a
projectile inside the vehicle. The force required to NOTE:
hold even an infant on your lap could become so • For additional information, refer to www.seatcheck.org
great that you could not hold the child, no matter
or call 1-866-732-8243.
how strong you are. The child and others could be
• Canadian residents should refer to Transport Canada’s
badly injured. Any child riding in your vehicle
website for additional information: www.tc.gc.ca/eng/
should be in a proper restraint for the child’s size.
motorvehiclesafety/safedrivers-childsafety-index-53.htm
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 73
Summary Of Recommendations For Restraining Children In Vehicles
Infants and
Toddlers
Small Children
Larger Children
Children Too Large
for Child Restraints
Child Size, Height, Weight Or Age
Children who are two years old or
younger and who have not reached the
height or weight limits of their child
restraint
Children who are at least two years old or
who have out-grown the height or weight
limit of their rear-facing child restraint
Children who have out-grown their
forward-facing child restraint, but are too
small to properly fit the vehicle’s seat belt
Children 12 years old or younger, who
have out-grown the height or weight limit
of their booster seat
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Recommended Type Of Child Restraint
Either an Infant Carrier or a Convertible
Child Restraint, facing rearward in the rear
seat of the vehicle
Forward-Facing Child Restraint with a
five-point Harness, facing forward in the
rear seat of the vehicle
Belt Positioning Booster Seat and the
vehicle seat belt, seated in the rear seat of
the vehicle
Vehicle Seat Belt, seated in the rear seat of
the vehicle
2
74 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Infants And Child Restraints
WARNING!
Safety experts recommend that children ride rear-facing
in the vehicle until they are two years old or until they
reach either the height or weight limit of their rear-facing
child restraint. Two types of child restraints can be used
rear-facing: infant carriers and convertible child seats.
The infant carrier is only used rear-facing in the vehicle.
It is recommended for children from birth until they
reach the weight or height limit of the infant carrier.
Convertible child seats can be used either rear-facing or
forward-facing in the vehicle. Convertible child seats
often have a higher weight limit in the rear-facing
direction than infant carriers do, so they can be used
rear-facing by children who have outgrown their infant
carrier but are still less than at least two years old.
Children should remain rear-facing until they reach the
highest weight or height allowed by their convertible
child seat.
• Never place a rear-facing child restraint in front of
an air bag. A deploying passenger Advanced Front
Air Bag can cause death or serious injury to a child
12 years or younger, including a child in a rearfacing child restraint.
• Only use a rear-facing child restraint in a vehicle
with a rear seat.
Older Children And Child Restraints
Children who are two years old or who have outgrown
their rear-facing convertible child seat can ride forwardfacing in the vehicle. Forward-facing child seats and
convertible child seats used in the forward-facing direction are for children who are over two years old or who
have outgrown the rear-facing weight or height limit of
their rear-facing convertible child seat. Children should
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 75
remain in a forward-facing child seat with a harness for
as long as possible, up to the highest weight or height
allowed by the child seat.
All children whose weight or height is above the
forward-facing limit for the child seat should use a
belt-positioning booster seat until the vehicle’s seat belts
fit properly. If the child cannot sit with knees bent over
the vehicle’s seat cushion while the child’s back is against
the seatback, they should use a belt-positioning booster
seat. The child and belt-positioning booster seat are held
in the vehicle by the seat belt.
WARNING!
• Improper installation can lead to failure of an
infant or child restraint. It could come loose in a
collision. The child could be badly injured or
killed. Follow the child restraint manufacturer’s
WARNING! (Continued)
directions exactly when installing an infant or
child restraint.
• After a child restraint is installed in the vehicle, do
not move the vehicle seat forward or rearward
because it can loosen the child restraint attachments. Remove the child restraint before adjusting
the vehicle seat position. When the vehicle seat has
been adjusted, reinstall the child restraint.
• When your child restraint is not in use, secure it in
the vehicle with the seat belt or LATCH anchorages, or remove it from the vehicle. Do not leave it
loose in the vehicle. In a sudden stop or accident, it
could strike the occupants or seatbacks and cause
serious personal injury.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
(Continued)
2
76 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Children Too Large For Booster Seats
5. Can the child stay seated like this for the whole trip?
Children who are large enough to wear the shoulder belt
comfortably, and whose legs are long enough to bend
over the front of the seat when their back is against the
seatback, should use the seat belt in a rear seat. Use this
simple 5-step test to decide whether the child can use the
vehicle’s seat belt alone:
If the answer to any of these questions was “no,” then the
child still needs to use a booster seat in this vehicle. If the
child is using the lap/shoulder belt, check seat belt fit
periodically and make sure the seat belt buckle is latched.
A child’s squirming or slouching can move the belt out of
position. If the shoulder belt contacts the face or neck,
move the child closer to the center of the vehicle, or use a
booster seat to position the seat belt on the child correctly.
1. Can the child sit all the way back against the back of
the vehicle seat?
2. Do the child’s knees bend comfortably over the front
of the vehicle seat – while they are still sitting all the
way back?
3. Does the shoulder belt cross the child’s shoulder
between their neck and arm?
4. Is the lap part of the belt as low as possible, touching
the child’s thighs and not their stomach?
WARNING!
Never allow a child to put the shoulder belt under an
arm or behind their back. In a crash, the shoulder belt
will not protect a child properly, which may result in
serious injury or death. A child must always wear both
the lap and shoulder portions of the seat belt correctly.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 77
Recommendations For Attaching Child Restraints
Restraint Type
Combined
Weight of the
Child + Child
Restraint
Rear-Facing
Child Restraint
Rear-Facing
Child Restraint
Forward-Facing
Child Restraint
Forward-Facing
Child Restraint
Up to 65 lbs
(29.5 kg)
More than
65 lbs (29.5 kg)
Up to 65 lbs
(29.5 kg)
More than
65 lbs (29.5 kg)
Use any attachment method shown with an “X” Below
LATCH –
Seat Belt Only
LATCH –
Seat Belt + Top
Lower Anchors
Lower Anchors
Tether Anchor
Only
+ Top Tether
Anchor
X
X
X
X
X
X
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
78 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
seating position. These anchorages are used to install
LATCH-equipped child seats without using the vehicle’s
seat belts. Some seating positions may have a top tether
anchorage but no lower anchorages. In these seating
positions, the seat belt must be used with the top tether
anchorage to install the child restraint. Please see the
following table for more information.
Lower Anchors And Tethers For CHildren
(LATCH) Restraint System
Your vehicle is equipped with the child restraint anchorage system called LATCH, which stands for Lower
Anchors and Tethers for CHildren. The LATCH system
has three vehicle anchor points for installing LATCHequipped child seats. There are two lower anchorages
located at the back of the seat cushion where it meets the
seatback and one top tether anchorage located behind the
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 79
LATCH Positions For Installing Child Restraints In
This Vehicle
2
•
•
Lower Anchorage Symbol 2 anchorages per
seating position
Top Tether Anchorage Symbol
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
80 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
What is the weight limit (child’s weight +
weight of the child restraint) for using the
LATCH anchorage system to attach the child
restraint?
65 lbs
(29.5 kg)
Can the LATCH anchorages and the seat belt
be used together to attach a rear-facing or
forward-facing child restraint?
Can two child restraints be attached using a
common lower LATCH anchorage?
No
No
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Use the LATCH anchorage system until the
combined weight of the child and the child
restraint is 65 lbs (29.5 kg). Use the seat belt
and tether anchor instead of the LATCH
system once the combined weight is more
than 65 lbs (29.5 kg).
Do not use the seat belt when you use the
LATCH anchorage system to attach a rearfacing or forward-facing child restraint.
Never “share” a LATCH anchorage with two
or more child restraints. If the center position
does not have dedicated LATCH lower anchorages, use the seat belt to install a child
seat in the center position next to a child seat
using the LATCH anchorages in an
outboard position.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 81
Can the rear-facing child restraint touch the
back of the front passenger seat?
Can the head restraints be removed?
Yes
Yes
The child seat may touch the back of the front
passenger seat if the child restraint manufacturer also allows contact. See your child restraint owner’s manual for more information.
Yes, all may be removed
Locating LATCH Anchorages
The lower anchorages are round bars that are
found at the rear of the seat cushion where it
meets the seatback, below the anchorage symbols on the seatback. They are just visible when
you lean into the rear seat to install the child restraint.
You will easily feel them if you run your finger along the
gap between the seatback and seat cushion.
LATCH Anchorages
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
82 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
LATCH-compatible child restraint systems will be
equipped with a rigid bar or a flexible strap on each side.
There are tether strap anchorages behind each Each will have a hook or connector to attach to the lower
rear seating position located on the back of the anchorage and a way to tighten the connection to the
anchorage. Forward-facing child restraints and some
seat.
rear-facing child restraints will also be equipped with a
tether strap. The tether strap will have a hook at the end
to attach to the top tether anchorage and a way to tighten
the strap after it is attached to the anchorage.
Locating Tether Anchorages
Center Seat LATCH
WARNING!
This vehicle does not have a center seating position.
Do not use the center lower LATCH anchorages to
install a child seat in the center of the back seat.
Rear Seat Tether Strap Mounting
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 83
Always follow the directions of the child restraint manufacturer when installing your child restraint. Not all child
restraint systems will be installed as described here.
To Install A LATCH-Compatible Child Restraint
forward and rearward in the vehicle, you may wish to
move it to its rear-most position to make room for the
child seat. You may also move the front seat forward
to allow more room for the child seat.
3. Attach the lower hooks or connectors of the child
If the selected seating position has a Switchable Autorestraint to the lower anchorages in the selected seatmatic Locking Retractor (ALR) seat belt, stow the seat
ing position.
belt, following the instructions below. See the section
“Installing Child Restraints Using the Vehicle Seat Belt” 4. If the child restraint has a tether strap, connect it to the
to check what type of seat belt each seating position has.
top tether anchorage. See the section “Installing Child
Restraints Using the Top Tether Anchorage” for direc1. Loosen the adjusters on the lower straps and on the
tions to attach a tether anchor.
tether strap of the child seat so that you can more
easily attach the hooks or connectors to the vehicle 5. Tighten all of the straps as you push the child restraint
anchorages.
rearward and downward into the seat. Remove slack
in the straps according to the child restraint manufac2. Place the child seat between the lower anchorages for
turer’s instructions.
that seating position. For some second row seats, you
may need to recline the seat and / or raise the head
restraint to get a better fit. If the rear seat can be moved
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
84 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
6. Test that the child restraint is installed tightly by
pulling back and forth on the child seat at the belt
path. It should not move more than 1 inch (25.4 mm)
in any direction.
How To Stow An Unused ALR Seat Belt:
When using the LATCH attaching system to install a child
restraint, stow all ALR seat belts that are not being used by
other occupants or being used to secure child restraints.
An unused belt could injure a child if they play with it and
accidentally lock the seat belt retractor. Before installing a
child restraint using the LATCH system, buckle the seat
belt behind the child restraint and out of the child’s reach.
If the buckled seat belt interferes with the child restraint
installation, instead of buckling it behind the child restraint, route the seat belt through the child restraint belt
path and then buckle it. Do not lock the seat belt. Remind
all children in the vehicle that the seat belts are not toys
and that they should not play with them.
WARNING!
• Improper installation of a child restraint to the
LATCH anchorages can lead to failure of the restraint. The child could be badly injured or killed.
Follow the child restraint manufacturer’s directions
exactly when installing an infant or child restraint.
• Child restraint anchorages are designed to withstand only those loads imposed by correctly-fitted
child restraints. Under no circumstances are they to
be used for adult seat belts, harnesses, or for
attaching other items or equipment to the vehicle.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 85
Installing Child Restraints Using The Vehicle Seat
Belt
Lap/Shoulder Belt Systems For Installing Child
Restraints In This Vehicle
The seat belts in the passenger seating positions are
equipped with a Switchable Automatic Locking Retractor
(ALR) that is designed to keep the lap portion of the seat
belt tight around the child restraint so that it is not
necessary to use a locking clip. The ALR retractor can be
“switched” into a locked mode by pulling all of the
webbing out of the retractor and then letting the webbing
retract back into the retractor. If it is locked, the ALR will
make a clicking noise while the webbing is pulled back
into the retractor. Refer to the “Automatic Locking
Mode” description under “Occupant Restraints” for additional information on ALR.
2
• ALR = Switchable Automatic Locking Retractor
•
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Top Tether Anchorage Symbol
86 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
What is the weight limit (child’s weight +
weight of the child restraint) for using the
Tether Anchor with the seat belt to attach a
forward facing child restraint?
Can the rear-facing child restraint touch
the back of the front passenger seat?
Weight limit of the
Child Restraint
Can the head restraints be removed?
Can the buckle stalk be twisted to tighten
the seat belt against the belt path of the
child restraint?
Yes
No
Yes
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Always use the tether anchor when using
the seat belt to install a forward facing
child restraint, up to the recommended
weight limit of the child restraint.
Contact between the front passenger seat
and the child restraint is allowed, if the
child restraint manufacturer also allows
contact.
Yes, all may be removed
Do not twist the buckle stalk in a seating
position with an ALR retractor.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 87
5. To lock the seat belt, pull down on the shoulder part of
the belt until you have pulled all the seat belt webbing
out of the retractor. Then, allow the webbing to retract
1. Place the child seat in the center of the seating
back into the retractor. As the webbing retracts, you
position. For some second row seats, you may need to
will hear a clicking sound. This means the seat belt is
recline the seat and/or raise the head restraint to get a
now in the Automatic Locking mode.
better fit. If the rear seat can be moved forward and
rearward in the vehicle, you may wish to move it to its 6. Try to pull the webbing out of the retractor. If it is
locked, you should not be able to pull out any webrear-most position to make room for the child seat.
You may also move the front seat forward to allow
bing. If the retractor is not locked, repeat step 5.
more room for the child seat.
7. Finally, pull up on any excess webbing to tighten the
lap portion around the child restraint while you push
2. Pull enough of the seat belt webbing from the retractor
to pass it through the belt path of the child restraint.
the child restraint rearward and downward into the
vehicle seat.
Do not twist the belt webbing in the belt path.
Installing A Child Restraint With A Switchable
Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)
3. Slide the latch plate into the buckle until you hear a 8. If the child restraint has a top tether strap and the
“click.”
seating position has a top tether anchorage, connect
the tether strap to the anchorage and tighten the tether
4. Pull on the webbing to make the lap portion tight
against the child seat.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
88 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
strap. See the section “Installing Child Restraints
Using the Top Tether Anchorage” for directions to
attach a tether anchor.
9. Test that the child restraint is installed tightly by
pulling back and forth on the child seat at the belt
path. It should not move more than 1 inch (25.4 mm)
in any direction.
WARNING! (Continued)
tether strap of a rear-facing car seat to the tether
anchorage that is approved for that seating position,
located behind the top of the vehicle seat. See the
section “Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren
(LATCH) Restraint System” for the location of approved tether anchorages in your vehicle.
Any seat belt system will loosen with time, so check the
belt occasionally, and pull it tight if necessary.
Installing Child Restraints Using The Top Tether
Anchorage
WARNING!
Do not attach a tether strap for a rear-facing car seat
to any location in front of the car seat, including the
seat frame or a tether anchorage. Only attach the
1. Look behind the seating position where you plan to
install the child restraint to find the tether anchorage.
You may need to move the seat forward to provide
better access to the tether anchorage. If there is no top
(Continued)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 89
tether anchorage for that seating position, move the
child restraint to another position in the vehicle if one
is available.
2. Route the tether strap to provide the most direct path
for the strap between the anchor and the child seat. If
your vehicle is equipped with adjustable rear head
restraints, raise the head restraint, and where possible,
route the tether strap under the head restraint and
between the two posts. If not possible, lower the head
restraint and pass the tether strap around the outboard
side of the head restraint.
Rear Seat Tether Strap Mounting
3. Attach the tether strap hook of the child restraint to
4. Remove slack in the tether strap according to the child
the top tether anchorage as shown in the diagram.
restraint manufacturer’s instructions.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
90 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Pets should be restrained in the rear seat in pet harnesses
or pet carriers that are secured by seat belts.
WARNING!
• An incorrectly anchored tether strap could lead to
increased head motion and possible injury to the
child. Use only the anchorage position directly
behind the child seat to secure a child restraint top
tether strap.
• If your vehicle is equipped with a split rear seat,
make sure the tether strap does not slip into the
opening between the seatbacks as you remove
slack in the strap.
Transporting Pets
Air Bags deploying in the front seat could harm your pet.
An unrestrained pet will be thrown about and possibly
injured, or could injure a passenger during panic braking
or in a collision.
SAFETY TIPS
Transporting Passengers
NEVER TRANSPORT PASSENGERS IN THE CARGO
AREA.
WARNING!
• Do not leave children or animals inside parked
vehicles in hot weather. Interior heat build-up may
cause serious injury or death.
• It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area,
inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people
riding in these areas are more likely to be seriously
injured or killed.
(Continued)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 91
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not allow people to ride in any area of your
vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat
belts.
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
using a seat belt properly.
Safety Checks You Should Make Inside The
Vehicle
Seat Belts
Inspect the seat belt system periodically, checking for
cuts, frays, and loose parts. Damaged parts must be
replaced immediately. Do not disassemble or modify the
system.
Front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a
collision. Rear seat belt assemblies must be replaced after
a collision if they have been damaged (i.e., bent retractor,
torn webbing, etc.). If there is any question regarding seat
belt or retractor condition, replace the seat belt.
Air Bag Warning Light
The Air Bag warning light
will turn on for four to
eight seconds as a bulb check when the ignition switch
is first turned to ON/RUN. If the light is either not on
during starting, stays on, or turns on while driving,
have the system inspected at an authorized dealer as
soon as possible. This light will illuminate with a
single chime when a fault with the Air Bag Warning
Light has been detected, it will stay on until the fault
is cleared. If the light comes on intermittently or
remains on while driving, have an authorized dealer
service the vehicle immediately. Refer to “Occupant
Restraints” in “Things To Know Before Starting Your
Vehicle” for further information.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
92 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Defroster
WARNING!
Check operation by selecting the defrost mode and
place the blower control on high speed. You should be
able to feel the air directed against the windshield. See
your authorized dealer for service if your defroster is
inoperable.
Floor Mat Safety Information
Always use floor mats designed to fit the footwell of your
vehicle. Use only floor mats that leave the pedal area
unobstructed and that are firmly secured so that they
cannot slip out of position and interfere with the pedals
or impair safe operation of your vehicle in other ways.
Pedals that cannot move freely can cause loss of
vehicle control and increase the risk of serious personal injury.
• Always make sure that floor mats are properly
attached to the floor mat fasteners.
• Never place or install floor mats or other floor
coverings in the vehicle that cannot be properly
secured to prevent them from moving and interfering with the pedals or the ability to control the
vehicle.
• Never put floor mats or other floor coverings on top
of already installed floor mats. Additional floor
mats and other coverings will reduce the size of the
pedal area and interfere with the pedals.
(Continued)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 93
WARNING! (Continued)
• Check mounting of mats on a regular basis. Always
properly reinstall and secure floor mats that have
been removed for cleaning.
• Always make sure that objects cannot fall into the
driver footwell while the vehicle is moving. Objects
can become trapped under the brake pedal and
accelerator pedal causing a loss of vehicle control.
• If required, mounting posts must be properly installed, if not equipped from the factory.
Failure to properly follow floor mat installation or
mounting can cause interference with the brake
pedal and accelerator pedal operation causing loss of
control of the vehicle.
Periodic Safety Checks You Should Make Outside
The Vehicle
Tires
Examine tires for excessive tread wear and uneven wear
patterns. Check for stones, nails, glass, or other objects
lodged in the tread or sidewall. Inspect the tread for cuts
and cracks. Inspect sidewalls for cuts, cracks and bulges.
Check the wheel bolts for tightness. Check the tires
(including spare) for proper cold inflation pressure.
Lights
Have someone observe the operation of brake lights and
exterior lights while you work the controls. Check turn
signal and high beam indicator lights on the instrument
panel.
Door Latches
Check for proper closing, latching, and locking.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
2
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CONTENTS
䡵 MIRRORS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
▫ Seat Height Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
▫ Inside Day/Night Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
▫ EZ Entry Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
▫ Automatic Dimming Mirror — If Equipped . . .98
▫ Memory Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
▫ Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
▫ Heated Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
▫ Folding Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101 䡵 TO OPEN AND CLOSE THE HOOD . . . . . . . . .106
▫ Heated Mirrors — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . .101 䡵 LIGHTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
▫ Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
▫ Multifunction Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
䡵 SEATS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
▫ Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
▫ Forward/Rearward Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . .103
▫ High Beams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
▫ Recline Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103
▫ Flash-To-Pass. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
3
96 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
▫ Parking Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
▫ To Activate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
▫ Daytime Running Lights. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
▫ To Set A Desired Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
▫ Turn Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
▫ To Deactivate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
▫ Lane Change Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
▫ To Resume Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
▫ Follow Me Home/Headlight Delay . . . . . . . . .111
▫ To Vary The Speed Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120
▫ Interior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
▫ To Accelerate For Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121
▫ Ambient Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113 䡵 REAR PARK ASSIST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .122
▫ Front Fog Lights — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . .113
▫ Rear Park Assist Sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .122
䡵 WINDSHIELD WIPERS AND WASHERS . . . . . .114
▫ Rear Park Assist Audible Alerts . . . . . . . . . . .122
▫ Front Windshield Wiper Operation . . . . . . . . .114
▫ Failure Indications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124
▫ Rear Windshield Wiper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
▫ Cleaning The Rear Park Assist System . . . . . . .124
䡵 TILT STEERING COLUMN — IF EQUIPPED . . .117
▫ Park Assist System Usage Precautions . . . . . . .125
䡵 ELECTRONIC SPEED CONTROL . . . . . . . . . . .118 䡵 POWER SUNROOF — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . .126
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 97
▫ To Open . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128 䡵 CIGAR LIGHTER — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . .132
▫ To Close . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128 䡵 CUPHOLDERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133
▫ Pinch Protect Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128 䡵 STORAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134
▫ Wind Buffeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128
▫ Glove Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134
▫ Emergency Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129 䡵 CARGO AREA FEATURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134
▫ Sun Shade — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129 䡵 REAR WINDOW FEATURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136
䡵 ELECTRICAL POWER OUTLETS . . . . . . . . . . .129
▫ Rear Window Defroster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
3
98 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
MIRRORS
Inside Day/Night Mirror
The mirror can be adjusted up, down, left, and right for
various drivers. The mirror should be adjusted to center
on the view through the rear window.
Headlight glare from vehicles behind you can be reduced
by moving the small control under the mirror to the night
position (toward the rear of the vehicle). The mirror
should be adjusted while set in the day position (toward
the windshield).
Adjusting Rearview Mirror
Automatic Dimming Mirror — If Equipped
This mirror automatically adjusts for headlight glare
from vehicles behind you. You can turn the feature on or
off by pushing the button at the base of the mirror. The
On/Off symbol on the button will illuminate when the
auto-dimming feature is enabled.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 99
NOTE: This feature is disabled when the vehicle is
moving in reverse.
CAUTION!
To avoid damage to the mirror during cleaning, never
spray any cleaning solution directly onto the mirror.
Apply the solution onto a clean cloth and wipe the
mirror clean.
Power Mirrors
The power mirror controls are located on the driver’s
door trim panel.
Automatic Dimming Mirror
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
3
100 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Using the mirror control switch, push on any of the four
arrows for the direction that you want the mirror to
move.
WARNING!
Vehicles and other objects seen in the passenger side
convex mirror will look smaller and farther away
than they really are. Relying too much on your
passenger side mirror could cause you to collide with
another vehicle or other object. Use your inside
mirror when judging the size or distance of a vehicle
seen in the passenger side convex mirror.
Power Mirror Switches
The power mirror controls consist of a mirror select
switch and a four-way mirror control switch. To adjust a
mirror, push the mirror select switch to either the L (left)
or R (right) to select the mirror you need to adjust.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 101
Spotter Mirror — If Equipped
Folding Mirrors
Some models are equipped with a driver’s side spotter The exterior mirrors are hinged to allow the mirror to
mirror. The spotter mirror allows for a greater range of pivot forward or rearward to help avoid damage. The
visibility on the driver’s side of the vehicle.
mirror has three detent positions: full forward, normal
and full rearward.
Heated Mirrors — If Equipped
These mirrors are heated to melt frost or ice. This
feature can be activated whenever you turn on the
rear window defroster (if equipped). Refer to “Rear
Window Features” in “Understanding The Features Of
Your Vehicle” for further information.
Spotter Mirror
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
3
102 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Sun Visors
SEATS
The driver and passenger sun visors are located on the Seats are a part of the Occupant Restraint System of the
headliner, near the front windshield. The sun visor can be vehicle.
rotated downward or up against the door glass. Both sun
visors are equipped with courtesy mirrors.
WARNING!
• It is dangerous to ride in a cargo area, inside or
outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in
these areas are more likely to be seriously injured
or killed.
• Do not allow people to ride in any area of your
vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat
belts. In a collision, people riding in these areas are
more likely to be seriously injured or killed.
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
using a seat belt properly.
Sun Visor (Passenger Side Shown)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 103
Forward/Rearward Adjustment
The adjusting bar is located at the front of the seats, near
the floor.
move forward and rearward on the seat to be sure that
the seat adjusters have latched.
WARNING!
• Adjusting a seat while driving may be dangerous.
Moving a seat while driving could result in loss of
control which could cause a collision and serious
injury or death.
• Seats should be adjusted before fastening the seat
belts and while the vehicle is parked. Serious
injury or death could result from a poorly adjusted
seat belt.
Recline Adjustment
The recline adjustment lever is located on the inboard
side of the seat. To recline the seatback, lift up the recline
While sitting in the seat, lift up on the bar and move the lever, lean back until the desired position has been
seat forward or rearward. Release the bar once the reached, and release the lever.
desired position is reached. Then, using body pressure,
Adjusting Bar
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
3
104 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Seat Height Adjustment
The driver’s seat height can be raised or lowered by
using a lever, located on the outboard side of the seat.
Pump the lever upward to raise the seat height, or pump
the lever downward to lower the seat height.
Recline Lever
WARNING!
Do not ride with the seatback reclined so that the
shoulder belt is no longer resting against your chest.
In a collision you could slide under the seat belt,
which could result in serious injury or death.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Height Adjuster
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 105
Lift the seatback upright and push the seat rearward to
The driver and front passenger seats have an EZ entry its locked position once the rear passengers are seated.
feature for rear seat passengers. Pull forward on the Memory Feature
release lever, located on the outboard side of the seatback,
Both front seats have a memory feature, which can
dump the seatback forward, then slide the seat forward
operate in two ways:
to allow access in and out of the rear seat.
Memory Function Option 1 — Full Seat Back And
Track Fore/Aft Position Memory:
EZ Entry Feature
After using the EZ entry function, the seatback angle and
the Track fore/aft adjuster can both re-lock into the
position they were most recently adjusted to. This is
accomplished if the seat is moved fully rearward to its
last fore/aft position on the tracks before the seat back is
returned upright.
Memory Function Option 2 — Seat Back Only
Memory:
EZ Entry Lever
After using the EZ entry function, the seat back may first
be returned upright prior to going back to the last
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
3
106 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
fore/aft (memory) position on the tracks. This results in
the seat back memory being set only – The track will then
be locked forward of its last set fore/aft memory position. To then reset the fore/aft track memory feature (to
reestablish Memory Function Option 1), the seat has to be
returned fully rearward to its last fore/aft memory track
position as described in Memory Function Option 1.
Heated Seats
On some models, the front driver and passenger seats
may be equipped with heaters in both the seat cushions
and seatbacks. The controls for the front heated seats are
located on the center instrument panel area.
Push the switch once to turn on the heated
seats. Push the switch a second time to shut the
heating elements off.
WARNING!
• Persons who are unable to feel pain to the skin
because of advanced age, chronic illness, diabetes,
spinal cord injury, medication, alcohol use, exhaustion or other physical condition must exercise care
when using the seat heater. It may cause burns
even at low temperatures, especially if used for
long periods of time.
• Do not place anything on the seat or seatback that
insulates against heat, such as a blanket or cushion.
This may cause the seat heater to overheat. Sitting
in a seat that has been overheated could cause
serious burns due to the increased surface temperature of the seat.
TO OPEN AND CLOSE THE HOOD
NOTE: Once a heat setting is selected, heat will be felt
To open the hood, two latches must be released.
within two to five minutes.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 107
1. Pull the bottom of the RED hood release lever, located
on the left kick panel, rearward.
3
Hood Safety Latch Location
3. Lift the hood prop rod that clips to the right side (left
side when standing in front of the hood) of the engine
Hood Release Lever
compartment. Place the hood prop rod in the hole of
2. Rotate the safety catch under the front edge of the
hood hinge to secure the hood in the open position.
hood, near the center, and raise the hood.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
108 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
To prevent possible damage, do not slam the hood to
close it. Lower hood to approximately 12 in (30 cm)
and drop the hood to close. Make sure hood is fully
closed for both latches. Never drive vehicle unless
hood is fully closed, with both latches engaged.
WARNING!
Hood Prop Rod
In hot climates, the prop rod may be hot. Pick up the prop
rod at the foam on the end of the prop rod.
Be sure the hood is fully latched before driving your
vehicle. If the hood is not fully latched, it could open
when the vehicle is in motion and block your vision.
Failure to follow this warning could result in serious
injury or death.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 109
LIGHTS
Multifunction Lever
The multifunction lever, located on the left side of the
steering wheel, controls the operation of the headlights,
headlight beam selection, passing light and turn signals.
3
NOTE: The headlights can only be turned on with the
ignition in the ON/RUN position.
Headlights
Rotate the end of the multifunction lever upward to the first detent for headlight operation.
Headlight Operation
NOTE: When the headlights are turned on, the Daytime
Running Lights will be deactivated.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
110 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
High Beams
Daytime Running Lights
To activate the Daytime Running Lights (DRL), rotate the
With the low beams activated, push the multi- end of the multifunction lever to the O symbol.
function lever towards the instrument panel to
NOTE: The low beams and side/taillights will not be on
turn on the high beams. Pull the multifunction lever
with DRL.
toward the steering wheel to turn off the high beams.
If allowed by law in the country in which the vehicle was
Flash-To-Pass
purchased the DRL function can be turned on or off using
You can signal another vehicle with your headlights by the display menus. Refer to “UConnect settings” in
partially pulling the multifunction lever toward the steer- “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further ining wheel. This will cause the high beam headlights to formation.
turn on until the lever is released.
Turn Signals
Parking Lights
Push the multifunction lever upward to signal a right
turn or downward to signal a left turn. The correspondTo turn on the parking lights, remove the key ing indicator in the instrument cluster will blink to
or turn the ignition to OFF/LOCK position and indicate the operation of the turn signal.
turn on the headlights.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 111
Lane Change Assist
Tap the lever up or down once, without moving beyond
the detent, and the turn signal (right or left) will flash
three times then automatically turn off.
Follow Me Home/Headlight Delay
When this feature is selected the driver can choose to
have the headlights remain on for a preset period of time.
Activation
Remove the key or turn the ignition to the OFF/LOCK
position, and pull the multifunction lever toward the
Turn Signal Operation
steering wheel, within two minutes. Each time the lever
NOTE: The indicators will automatically turn off when is pulled, the activation of the lights will be extended by
the turn has been completed and the steering wheel is 30 seconds. The activation of the lights can be extended to
returned to a straight position.
a maximum of 210 seconds.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
3
112 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Deactivation
CAUTION!
Pull the multifunction lever toward the steering wheel
and hold it for more than two seconds.
Interior Lights
Before getting out of the vehicle be sure that the
switch is in the center position or that the lights are
off to avoid draining the battery.
The interior light switches are located in the overhead
Interior Light Timing (Center Position)
console. The interior lights can be set to three different
positions (Off/Left Position, Center Position, On/Right There are four different modes of operation that can be
activated in this position:
Position).
Using the switch on the left overhead, push the switch to • When one door is opened a three minute timer is
the right from its center position and the lights are always
activated.
on. Push the switch to the left from its center position and
• When the key is removed from the ignition (within
the lights are always off. Leave the switch in the center
two minutes of the ignition being turned off), a 10
position, and the lights are turned on and off when the
second timer is activated.
doors are opened or closed. The switch on the right side
of the overhead console controls the map or reading • When the doors are unlocked with the Key Fob a 10
function of the lights. Push the switch to the right to turn
second timer is activated.
on the right light and push the switch to the left to turn
on the left light.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 113
• When the doors are locked with the Key Fob the lights
will turn off.
Interior Light Timing (On/Right Position)
• When all doors are closed a 15 minute timer is
activated.
NOTE: The timer is deactivated when the key is moved
into the ON/RUN position.
Ambient Light
The vehicle is equipped with ambient light on the center
Fog Light Switch
stack. The ambient light will be on when the headlights
Push the switch once to turn the front fog lights on. Push
are turn on by rotating the end of the multifunction lever.
the switch a second time to turn the front fog lights off.
Front Fog Lights — If Equipped
The fog light switch is located on the center stack of the
instrument panel, just below the radio.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
3
114 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WINDSHIELD WIPERS AND WASHERS
The windshield wiper/washer lever is located on the
right side of the steering column.
NOTE: The windshield wipers/washers will only operate with the ignition in the ON/RUN position.
Front Windshield Wiper Operation
There are five different modes of operation for the front
windshield wipers. The windshield wiper lever can be
raised or lowered to access these modes:
Windshield Wiper Operation
Windshield Wiper Off
This is the normal position of the wiper lever.
Intermittent Wiper Operation
Push the lever downward to the first detent. The wipers
will operate intermittently.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 115
NOTE: The Intermittent function only has one detent but Front Windshield Washer Operation
wiper delay will vary with changes in vehicle speed. As Pull the windshield wiper/washer lever toward the
vehicle speed increases the delay time will decrease.
steering wheel to activate the washers. The wipers will
activate automatically for three cycles after the lever is
Low Speed
released.
Push the lever downward to the second detent. The
wipers will operate at low speed.
CAUTION!
High Speed
Push the lever downward to the third detent. The wipers
will operate at high speed.
Manual High Speed/Mist
Push the lever upward from the off position. The wipers
will operate at high speed to clear off road mist or spray
from a passing vehicle. This operation will continue until
the lever is released. When the lever is released, the
wipers will return to the off position and automatically
shut off.
• Turn the windshield wipers off when driving
through an automatic car wash. Damage to the
windshield wipers may result if the wiper control
is left in any position other than off.
• In cold weather, always turn off the wiper switch
and allow the wipers to return to the “Park” position before turning off the vehicle. If the wiper
switch is left on and the wipers freeze to the
windshield, damage to the wiper motor may occur
when the vehicle is restarted.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
(Continued)
3
116 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Always remove any buildup of snow that prevents
the windshield wiper blades from returning to the
off position. If the windshield wiper control is
turned off and the blades cannot return to the off
position, damage to the wiper motor may occur.
Rear Windshield Wiper
Rotate the end of the windshield wiper/washer lever
upward to the first detent past the intermittent settings
for intermittent wipe operation. With the front windshield wiper active, rotate the end of the windshield
wiper/washer lever upward. The rear wiper will operate
in the same mode as the front windshield wipers, but at
half the frequency. When the transmission is placed into
REVERSE, the rear wiper will automatically operate at
Low Speed and return to normal operation when the
transmission is placed out of REVERSE.
Rear Wiper Operation
NOTE: The windshield wipers/washers will only operate with the ignition in the ON/RUN position.
Rear Windshield Washer Operation
Push the windshield wiper/washer lever toward the
instrument panel to activate the rear washer. Push and
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 117
hold the lever for more than a half second and the wipers
will activate automatically for three cycles after the lever
is released.
TILT STEERING COLUMN — IF EQUIPPED
3
This feature allows you to tilt the steering column
upward or downward. The tilt control lever is located on
the left-side of the steering column, below the turn signal
controls.
Tilt Control Lever
Push down on the lever to unlock the column. With one
hand firmly on the steering wheel, move the steering
column up or down as desired. Push the lever up to lock
the column firmly in place.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
118 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
Do not adjust the steering column while driving.
Adjusting the steering column while driving or driving with the steering column unlocked, could cause the
driver to lose control of the vehicle. Failure to follow
this warning may result in serious injury or death.
ELECTRONIC SPEED CONTROL
When engaged, the Electronic Speed Control takes over
accelerator operations at speeds greater than 25 mph
(40 km/h).
Electronic Speed Control Buttons
The Electronic Speed Control buttons are located on the NOTE: In order to ensure proper operation, the Electronic Speed Control system has been designed to shut
right side of the steering wheel.
down if multiple Speed Control functions are operated at
the same time. If this occurs, the Electronic Speed Control
system can be reactivated by pushing the Electronic
Speed Control ON/OFF button and resetting the desired
vehicle set speed.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 119
To Activate
To Set A Desired Speed
Push the ON/OFF button. The Cruise Indicator Light in
the instrument cluster will illuminate. To turn the system
off, push the ON/OFF button a second time. The Cruise
Indicator Light will turn off. The system should be turned
off when not in use.
Turn the Electronic Speed Control ON. When the vehicle
has reached the desired speed, push the SET (-) button
and release. Release the accelerator and the vehicle will
operate at the selected speed.
WARNING!
NOTE: The vehicle should be traveling at a steady speed
and on level ground before pushing the SET (-) button.
To Deactivate
Leaving the Electronic Speed Control system on
when not in use is dangerous. You could accidentally
set the system or cause it to go faster than you want.
You could lose control and have an accident. Always
leave the system OFF when you are not using it.
A soft tap on the brake pedal, pushing the CANC button,
or normal brake pressure while slowing the vehicle will
deactivate Electronic Speed Control without erasing the set
speed memory. Pushing the ON/OFF button or turning the
ignition switch OFF erases the set speed in memory.
To Resume Speed
To resume a previously set speed, push the RES (+)
button and release. Resume can be used at any speed
above 20 mph (32 km/h).
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
3
120 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
To Vary The Speed Setting
Metric Speed (km/h)
• Pushing the RES (+) button once will result in a
1 km/h increase in set speed. Each subsequent tap of
When the Electronic Speed Control is set, you can inthe button results in an increase of 1 km/h.
crease speed by pushing the RES (+) button.
The drivers preferred units can be selected through the • If the button is continually pushed, the set speed will
continue to increase until the button is released, then
instrument panel settings if equipped. Refer to “Underthe new set speed will be established.
standing Your Instrument Panel” for more information.
The speed increment shown is dependent on the selected To Decrease Speed
speed unit of U.S. (mph) or Metric (km/h):
When the Electronic Speed Control is set, you can deU.S. Speed (mph)
crease speed by pushing the SET (-) button.
To Increase Speed
• Pushing the RES (+) button once will result in a 1 mph The drivers preferred units can be selected through the
increase in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the instrument panel settings if equipped. Refer to “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for more information.
button results in an increase of 1 mph.
The speed decrement shown is dependant on the selected
• If the button is continually pushed, the set speed will
speed unit of U.S. (mph) or Metric (km/h):
continue to increase until the button is released, then
the new set speed will be established.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 121
U.S. Speed (mph)
Using Electronic Speed Control On Hills
• Pushing the SET (-) button once will result in a 1 mph NOTE: The Electronic Speed Control system maintains
decrease in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the speed up and down hills. A slight speed change on
button results in a decrease of 1 mph.
moderate hills is normal.
• If the button is continually pushed, the set speed will On steep hills, a greater speed loss or gain may occur so
continue to decrease until the button is released, then it may be preferable to drive without Electronic Speed
the new set speed will be established.
Control.
Metric Speed (km/h)
• Pushing the SET (-) button once will result in a 1 km/h
decrease in set speed. Each subsequent tap of the
button results in a decrease of 1 km/h.
• If the button is continually pushed, the set speed will
continue to decrease until the button is released, then
the new set speed will be established.
To Accelerate For Passing
WARNING!
Electronic Speed Control can be dangerous where the
system cannot maintain a constant speed. Your vehicle could go too fast for the conditions, and you
could lose control and have an accident. Do not use
Electronic Speed Control in heavy traffic or on roads
that are winding, icy, snow-covered or slippery.
Press the accelerator as you would normally. When the
pedal is released, the vehicle will return to the set speed.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
3
122 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
REAR PARK ASSIST
The Rear Park Assist system provides audible indications
of the distance between the rear fascia/bumper and a
detected obstacle when backing up, e.g. during a parking
maneuver. Refer to the “Park Assist System Usage Precautions” for the limitations of this system and recommendations.
If several obstacles are detected, the Rear Park Assist
system indicates the nearest obstacle.
The minimum height of a detectable obstacle corresponds
to the maximum height of an obstacle that would clear the
underside of the car during the parking maneuver.
Rear Park Assist Audible Alerts
If an obstacle is behind the vehicle when the transmission
The Rear Park Assist is automatically activated when the is placed into REVERSE, an audible alert is activated.
transmission is placed into REVERSE.
The tones emitted by the loudspeaker inform the driver
Rear Park Assist Sensors
that the vehicle is approaching an obstacle. The pauses
The four Rear Park Assist sensors, located in the rear between the tones are directly proportional to the disfascia/bumper, monitor the area behind the vehicle that tance from the obstacle. Pulses emitted in quick succesis within the sensors’ field of view. The sensors can detect sion indicate the presence of a very close obstacle. A
obstacles, in the horizontal direction, from approximately continuous tone indicates that the obstacle is less than 12
12 in (30 cm) up to 55 in (140 cm) from the center of the in (30 cm) away.
rear fascia/bumper and up to 24 in (60 cm) from the
corners of the rear fascia/bumper, depending on the
location, type and orientation of the obstacle.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 123
Audible And Visual Signals Supplied By The Rear Park Assist System
SIGNAL
Obstacle Distance
Failure
MEANING
An obstacle is present within
the sensors’ field of view
Sensor or System failures
INDICATION
Audible signal (dashboard loudspeaker)
• Sound pulses emitted at a rate that increases as
the distance decreases.
• Emits continuous tone at 12 in (30 cm).
• Adjustable volume level. (Refer to “Electronic
Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information).
Visual Signal (instrument panel)
• Icon appears on display.
• Message is displayed on the Electronic Vehicle
Information Center (EVIC) (where provided).
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
3
124 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
While audible signals are emitted, the audio system is not Refer to ⬙Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)⬙ in
“Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further
muted.
information.
The audible signal is turned off immediately if the
distance increases. The tone cycle remains constant if the The sensors and wiring are tested continuously when the
distance measured by the inner sensors is constant. If this ignition is in the ON/RUN position. Failures are indicondition occurs for the external sensors, the signal is cated immediately if they occur when the system is ON.
turned off after 3 seconds (stopping warnings during Even if the system is able to identify that a specific sensor
maneuvers parallel to walls).
is in failure condition, the EVIC shall indicate that the
Rear Park Assist system is unavailable, without reference
to the sensor in failure condition. If even a single sensor
A malfunction of the Rear Park Assist sensors or system
fails, the entire system must be disabled. The system is
is indicated, during REVERSE gear engagement, by the
turned off automatically.
instrument panel warning icon and message displayed
on the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Cleaning The Rear Park Assist System
display.
Clean the Rear Park Assist sensors with water, car wash
Failure Indications
The warning icon is illuminated and a message soap and a soft cloth. Do not use rough or hard cloths. In
is displayed on the EVIC display (if equipped). washing stations, clean sensors quickly keeping the vapor jet/high pressure washing nozzles at least 4 in (10
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 125
cm) from the sensors. Do not scratch or poke the sensors.
Otherwise, you could damage the sensors.
Park Assist System Usage Precautions
not detect an obstacle behind the fascia/bumper, or it
could provide a false indication that an obstacle is
behind the fascia/bumper.
• Objects such as bicycle carriers, etc., must not be
placed within 12 in (30 cm) from the rear fascia/
• Ensure that the outer surface and the underside of the
bumper while driving the vehicle. Failure to do so can
rear bumper is clean and clear of snow, ice, mud, dirt
result in the system misinterpreting a close object as a
or other obstruction to keep the Rear Park Assist
sensor problem, causing a failure indication to be
system operating properly.
displayed in the instrument cluster.
NOTE:
• Jackhammers, large trucks, and other vibrations could
affect the performance of Rear Park Assist.
CAUTION!
• Clean the Rear Park Assist sensors regularly, taking
care not to scratch or damage them. The sensors must
not be covered with ice, snow, slush, mud, dirt or
debris. Failure to do so can result in the system not
working properly. The Rear Park Assist system might
• Rear Park Assist is only a parking aid and it is
unable to recognize every obstacle, including small
obstacles. Parking curbs might be temporarily detected or not detected at all. Obstacles located
above or below the sensors will not be detected
when they are in close proximity.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
(Continued)
3
126 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• The vehicle must be driven slowly when using
Rear Park Assist in order to be able to stop in time
when an obstacle is detected. It is recommended
that the driver looks over his/her shoulder when
using Rear Park Assist.
• Before using the Rear Park Assist System, it is
strongly recommended that the ball mount and
hitch ball assembly is disconnected from the vehicle when the vehicle is not used for towing.
Failure to do so can result in injury or damage to
vehicles or obstacles because the hitch ball will be
much closer to the obstacle than the rear fascia
when the warning display turns on the single
flashing arc and sounds the continuous tone. Also,
the sensors could detect the ball mount and hitch
ball assembly, depending on its size and shape,
giving a false indication that an obstacle is behind
the vehicle.
WARNING!
• Drivers must be careful when backing up even when
using the Rear Park Assist system. Always check
carefully behind your vehicle, look behind you, and
be sure to check for pedestrians, animals, other
vehicles, obstructions, and blind spots before backing up. You are responsible for safety and must
continue to pay attention to your surroundings. Failure to do so can result in serious injury or death.
(Continued)
POWER SUNROOF — IF EQUIPPED
The power sunroof roof switch is located in the overhead
console.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 127
WARNING! (Continued)
Power Sunroof Switch
WARNING!
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. Never leave the Key
Fob in or near the vehicle, or in a location accessible to children. Occupants, particularly unattended children, can become entrapped by the
power sunroof while operating the power sunroof
switch. Such entrapment may result in serious
injury or death.
• In a collision, there is a greater risk of being thrown
from a vehicle with an open sunroof. You could
also be seriously injured or killed. Always fasten
your seat belt properly and make sure all passengers are properly secured.
• Do not allow small children to operate the sunroof.
Never allow your fingers, other body parts, or any
object to project through the sunroof opening.
Injury may result.
(Continued)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
3
128 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
To Open
Pinch Protect Feature
Push and hold the power sunroof switch rearward for
approximately one second and the sunroof will stop at
the vented position. Push the switch a second time and
hold for approximately one second and release, the
sunroof will open fully, then stop automatically. This is
called “Express Open”. During Express Open operation,
any movement of the sunroof switch will stop the
sunroof.
This feature will detect an obstruction in the opening of
the sunroof during Express Close operation. If an obstruction in the path of the sunroof is detected, the
sunroof will automatically retract. Remove the obstruction if this occurs. Next, push the switch forward and
release to Express Close.
Wind Buffeting
Wind buffeting can be described as the perception of
pressure on the ears or a helicopter-type sound in the
With the sunroof in the full open position, pull the power ears. Your vehicle may exhibit wind buffeting with the
sunroof button and hold it for approximately one second, windows down, or the sunroof (if equipped) in certain
the sunroof will return to the vented position. Pull the open or partially open positions. This is a normal occurswitch a second time and hold for approximately one rence and can be minimized. If the buffeting occurs with
second to completely close the sunroof.
the rear windows open, open the front and rear windows
together to minimize the buffeting. If the buffeting occurs
with the sunroof open, adjust the sunroof opening to
minimize the buffeting or open any window.
To Close
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 129
Emergency Operation
In case of electrical failure, the sunroof can be operated
with the hex wrench that is located in the glove box.
There is a plug located in the rear of the sunroof opening
at the center of the vehicle. Removing the plug reveals a
hex opening in the motor assembly of the sunroof. Insert
the hex wrench and turn, moving the sunroof to the
desired location.
Sun Shade — If Equipped
For vehicles equipped with either a power sunroof or a
fixed glass roof, there is a sun shade that can be open or
Manual Sun Shade
closed. To open the sun shade, push the tab and move the
ELECTRICAL
POWER
OUTLETS
shade to a full open position.
There is a standard 12 Volt (13 Amp) power outlet,
located in the floor console, for added convenience. This
power outlet can power mobile phones, electronics and
other low power devices.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
3
130 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
• Do not exceed the maximum power of 160 Watts (13
Amps) at 12 Volts. If the 160 Watts (13 Amps) power
rating is exceeded, the fuse protecting the system
will need to be replaced.
• Power outlets are designed for accessory plugs
only. Do not insert any other object in the power
outlets as this will damage the outlet and blow the
fuse. Improper use of the power outlet can cause
damage not covered by your New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
Power Outlet
Power is available when the ignition switch is in the
ON/RUN or START position. Insert the cigar lighter or
accessory plug into the outlet for use. To preserve the
heating element, do not hold the lighter in the heating
position.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 131
WARNING!
To avoid serious injury or death:
• Only devices designed for use in this type of outlet
should be inserted into any 12 Volt outlet.
• Do not touch with wet hands.
• Close the lid when not in use and while driving the
vehicle.
• If this outlet is mishandled, it may cause an electric
shock and failure.
Power Outlet Fuse Location – Underhood
F15 Fuse 15 A Blue Cigar Lighter Front Console/Aux Power Outlet
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
3
132 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CIGAR LIGHTER — IF EQUIPPED
CAUTION!
• Many accessories that can be plugged in draw
power from the vehicle’s battery, even when not in
use (i.e., cellular phones, etc.). Eventually, if
plugged in long enough, the vehicle’s battery will
discharge sufficiently to degrade battery life and/or
prevent the engine from starting.
• Accessories that draw higher power (i.e., coolers,
vacuum cleaners, lights, etc.) will degrade the battery even more quickly. Only use these intermittently and with great caution.
• After the use of high power draw accessories, or
long periods of the vehicle not being started (with
accessories still plugged in), the vehicle must be
driven a sufficient length of time to allow the
generator to recharge the vehicle’s battery.
This is located on the center console, in front of the cup
holders. To activate the cigar lighter, push and release the
knob. After a few seconds the knob automatically returns
to its initial position, and the cigar lighter is ready for use.
WARNING!
When the cigar lighter is in use it becomes very hot.
To avoid serious injury, handle the cigar lighter with
care. Always check that the cigar lighter has turned
off.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 133
For rear passengers, there are cupholders located on the
For the driver and front passenger, cupholders are lo- floor between the front driver and passenger seats.
cated on the floor console between the front seats.
CUPHOLDERS
3
Rear Cupholders
Front Cupholders
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
134 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
STORAGE
CARGO AREA FEATURES
Glove Compartment
The glove compartment is located on the right side of the
instrument panel. Pull outward on the glove compartment latch to open the glove compartment. Push the
glove compartment door upward to close it.
The rear seatbacks have a fold down feature to allow
increased cargo capacity.
Glove Compartment Latch
Push down the release button, located at the outboard
top of the seatback and move the seatback to its foldeddown position to provide a flat load floor cargo area.
When returning the seatback to its upright position, push
rearward until the seatback is properly latched.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 135
3
Rear Seat Release Buttons
Folded Rear Seats
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
136 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
REAR WINDOW FEATURES
CAUTION!
Rear Window Defroster
The rear window defroster button is located in the
center of the instrument panel, below the radio.
Push this button to turn on the rear window defroster. An
indicator in the instrument panel cluster will illuminate
when the rear window defroster is on. The rear window
defroster automatically turns off after approximately 20
minutes. To manually shut the defroster off, push the
button a second time.
Failure to follow these cautions can cause damage to
the heating elements:
• Use care when washing the inside of the rear
window. Do not use abrasive window cleaners on
the interior surface of the window. Use a soft cloth
and a mild washing solution, wiping parallel to the
heating elements. Labels can be peeled off after
soaking with warm water.
• Do not use scrapers, sharp instruments, or abrasive
window cleaners on the interior surface of the
window.
• Keep all objects a safe distance from the window.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
CONTENTS
䡵 INSTRUMENT PANEL FEATURES . . . . . . . . . .139
▫ EVIC Control Buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
䡵 INSTRUMENT CLUSTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141
▫ Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
Setup Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .165
䡵 WARNING AND INDICATOR LIGHTS . . . . . . .142
▫ Red Telltale Indicator Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
▫ Yellow Telltale Indicator Lights . . . . . . . . . . . .150
▫ Green Telltale Indicator Lights . . . . . . . . . . . .160
▫ White Telltale Indicator Light . . . . . . . . . . . . .162
▫ Blue Telltale Indicator Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163
䡵 ELECTRONIC VEHICLE INFORMATION
CENTER (EVIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
▫ Trip Computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .167
䡵 UCONNECT RADIOS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
䡵 iPod/USB/MEDIA PLAYER CONTROL — IF
EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
䡵 UCONNECT SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
▫ Buttons On The Faceplate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
▫ Buttons On The Touchscreen. . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
138 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
▫ Customer Programmable Features — Uconnect
5.0 Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
▫ Harmful Interference Statement. . . . . . . . . . . .186
▫ Additional Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
䡵 UCONNECT 5.0 VOICE RECOGNITION QUICK
䡵 STEERING WHEEL AUDIO CONTROLS . . . .
TIPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .180
▫ Radio Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Introducing Uconnect. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .180
䡵 RADIO OPERATION AND MOBILE PHONES
▫ Get Started . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181
䡵 TELEMATICS MODEM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Basic Voice Commands. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .182
䡵 CLIMATE CONTROLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183
▫ Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) . . . .
▫ Media. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .184
▫ Operating Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Voice Text Reply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185
▫ Radio Operation And Mobile Phones. . . . . . . .186
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
. .187
. .187
. .188
. .188
. .189
. .189
. .190
. .195
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 139
INSTRUMENT PANEL FEATURES
4
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
140 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
1 — Side Vent
2 — Multifunction Lever – Light
Control (Behind Steering Wheel)
3 — Instrument Cluster And Electronic Vehicle Information Center
4 — Windshield Wiper, Washer,
Trip Computer (Behind Steering
Wheel)
5 — Central Air Vents
6 — Storage Compartment
7 — Passenger Air Bag
8 — Rear Defrost Button
11 — Power Window Controls
12 — Heated Seat Controls/Front
Fog Light Control
13 — ESC Off
9 — Hazard Button
14 — Horn/Driver Airbag
10 — Climate Controls
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 141
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
4
Instrument Cluster
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
142 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
1. Battery Charge Gauge
• This gauge indicates the charge level of the battery.
2. Speedometer
• Indicates vehicle speed.
WARNING AND INDICATOR LIGHTS
IMPORTANT: The warning / indicator light switches on
in the instrument panel together with a dedicated message and/or acoustic signal when applicable. These
indications are indicative and precautionary and as such
must not be considered as exhaustive and/or alternative
to the information contained in the Owner Manual,
which you are advised to read carefully in all cases.
Always refer to the information in this chapter in the
event of a failure indication.
3. Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
• When the appropriate conditions exist, this display
shows the Electronic Vehicle Information Center
(EVIC) messages. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information Center” in “Understanding Your Instrument
Panel” for further information
All active telltales will display first if applicable. The
system check menu may appear different based upon
4. Power Flow Gauge
equipment options and current vehicle status. Some
This gauge indicates how battery energy is being used by
telltales are optional and may not appear.
the vehicle:
• ECO Mode (Green): The vehicle is conserving energy.
• POWER Mode (Red): The vehicle is utilizing energy.
• CHARGE Mode (Purple): The vehicle is regenerating
energy.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 143
Red Telltale Indicator Lights
Seat Belt Reminder Warning Light
Red Telltale
Light
What It Means
Seat Belt Reminder Warning Light
When the ignition switch is first turned to ON/RUN, this light will turn on for four to eight
seconds as a bulb check. During the bulb check, if the driver’s seat belt is unbuckled, a
chime will sound. After the bulb check or when driving, if the driver seat belt remains unbuckled, the Seat Belt Reminder Light will flash or remain on continuously and a chime will
sound. Refer to “Occupant Restraints” in “Things To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle” for
further information.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
144 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Air Bag Warning Light
Red Telltale
Light
What It Means
Air Bag Warning Light
This light will turn on for four to eight seconds as a bulb check when the ignition switch is
first turned to ON/RUN. If the light is either not on during starting, stays on, or turns on
while driving, have the system inspected at an authorized dealer as soon as possible. This
light will illuminate with a single chime when a fault with the Air Bag Warning Light has
been detected, it will stay on until the fault is cleared. If the light comes on intermittently or
remains on while driving, have an authorized dealer service the vehicle immediately. Refer
to “Occupant Restraints” in “Things To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle” for further information.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 145
Brake Warning Light
Red Telltale
Light
United States
Canada
What It Means
Brake Warning Light
This light monitors various brake functions, including brake fluid level and parking brake
application. If the brake light turns on it may indicate that the parking brake is applied, that
the brake fluid level is low, or that there is a problem with the anti-lock brake system reservoir.
If the light remains on when the parking brake has been disengaged, and the fluid level is at
the full mark on the master cylinder reservoir, it indicates a possible brake hydraulic system
malfunction or that a problem with the Brake Booster has been detected by the Anti-Lock
Brake System (ABS) / Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system. In this case, the light will
remain on until the condition has been corrected. If the problem is related to the brake
booster, the ABS pump will run when applying the brake, and a brake pedal pulsation may
be felt during each stop.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
146 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
The dual brake system provides a reserve braking capacity in the event of a failure to a portion of the hydraulic
system. A leak in either half of the dual brake system is
indicated by the Brake Warning Light, which will turn on
when the brake fluid level in the master cylinder has
dropped below a specified level.
Vehicles equipped with the Anti-Lock Brake System
(ABS) are also equipped with Electronic Brake Force
Distribution (EBD). In the event of an EBD failure, the
Brake Warning Light will turn on along with the ABS
Light. Immediate repair to the ABS system is required.
If brake failure is indicated, immediate repair is necessary.
Operation of the Brake Warning Light can be checked by
turning the ignition switch from the OFF position to the
ON/RUN position. The light should illuminate for approximately two seconds. The light should then turn off
unless the parking brake is applied or a brake fault is
detected. If the light does not illuminate, have the light
inspected by an authorized dealer.
WARNING!
The light also will turn on when the parking brake is
applied with the ignition switch in the ON/RUN position.
Driving a vehicle with the red brake light on is
dangerous. Part of the brake system may have failed.
It will take longer to stop the vehicle. You could have
a collision. Have the vehicle checked immediately.
NOTE: This light shows only that the parking brake is
applied. It does not show the degree of brake application.
The light will remain on until the cause is corrected.
NOTE: The light may flash momentarily during sharp
cornering maneuvers, which change fluid level conditions. The vehicle should have service performed, and
the brake fluid level checked.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 147
Electric Power Steering Fail Warning — If Equipped
Red Telltale
Light
What It Means
Electric Power Steering Fail Warning
This light is used to manage the electrical warning of the EPS (Power Steering System). Refer to “Power Steering” in “Starting and Operating” for further information.
Plugged In Indicator Light
Red Telltale
Light
What It Means
Plugged In Indicator Light
This red indicator will illuminate if there is a malfunction or interruption during the vehicle
charging process.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
148 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Door Open Warning Light
Red Telltale Light
What It Means
Door Open Warning Light
This indicator will illuminate when a door is ajar/open and not fully closed. .
• Driver’s Door Open
• Passenger Door Open
• Driver and Passenger Door Open
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 149
Service Propulsion System Warning Light
Red Telltale
Light
What It Means
Service Propulsion System Warning Light
The Service Propulsion System Warning Light will illuminate if there is a malfunction detected with the Propulsion System. If the light comes on or remains on while driving see
your authorized dealer.
Charging System Warning Light
Red Telltale
Light
What It Means
Charging System Warning Light
This light shows the status of the electrical charging system. If the light comes on while driving, turn off some of the vehicle’s nonessential electrical devices or increase engine speed (if at
idle). If the charging system light remains on, it means that the vehicle is experiencing a problem with the charging system. Obtain SERVICE IMMEDIATELY. See an authorized dealer.
If jump starting is required, refer to “Jump Starting Procedures” in “What To Do In Emergencies.”
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
150 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Liftgate Open Warning Light
Red Telltale
Light
What It Means
Liftgate Open Warning Light
This indicator will turn when the liftgate is open.
Yellow Telltale Indicator Lights
EV System Malfunction Indicator Light
Yellow Telltale
Light
What It Means
EV System Malfunction Indicator Light
This indicator will illuminate when there is a malfunction in the Electric Vehicle (EV) System. If the EV System Malfunction Indicator light comes on while driving or charging see
your authorized dealer as soon as possible.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 151
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) Indicator Light — If Equipped
Yellow Telltale
Light
What It Means
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) Indicator Light
The “ESC Indicator Light” in the instrument cluster will come on when the ignition switch
is turned to the AVV/START position. If the “ESC Indicator Light” comes on continuously
with the engine running, a malfunction has been detected in the ESC system. If this light
remains on after several ignition cycles, and the vehicle has been driven several miles (kilometers) at speeds greater than 30 mph (48 km/h), see your authorized dealer as soon as
possible to have the problem diagnosed and corrected.
• The “ESC Off Indicator Light” and the “ESC Indicator Light” come on momentarily each
time the ignition switch is turned to AVV/START.
• Each time the ignition is turned to AVV/START, the ESC system will be ON, even if it
was turned off previously.
• The ESC system will make buzzing or clicking sounds when it is active. This is normal;
the sounds will stop when ESC becomes inactive following the maneuver that caused
the ESC activation.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
152 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) OFF Indicator Light — If Equipped
Yellow Telltale
Light
What It Means
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) OFF Indicator Light
This light indicates the Electronic Stability Control (ESC) is off.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 153
Tire Pressure Monitoring Indicator Light
Yellow Telltale
Light
What It Means
Tire Pressure Monitoring Indicator Light
The warning light switches on and a message is displayed to indicate that the tire pressure
is lower than the recommended value and/or that slow pressure loss is occurring. In these
cases, optimal tire duration and battery charge efficiency may not be guaranteed.
Should two or more tires be in the condition mentioned above, the display will show the
indications corresponding to each tire in sequence.
In any situation in which the message on the display is ⬙See manual⬙, it is ESSENTIAL to
refer to the contents of the ⬙Wheels⬙ paragraph in the ⬙Technical data⬙ chapter, strictly complying with the indications that you find there.
IMPORTANT: Do not continue driving with one or more
flat tires as handling may be compromised. Stop the
vehicle, avoiding sharp braking and steering. Repair
immediately using the dedicated tire repair kit and
contact your authorized dealership as soon as possible.
Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be
checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation
pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on
the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. If your
vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
154 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper
should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for tire maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to
those tires.
maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has
not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been
low tire pressure telltale.
equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one or Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS
more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. Accord- malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not
ingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is
should stop and check your tires as soon as possible and combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the
inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a signifi- system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for
cantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to overheat and approximately one minute and then remain continuously
can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also increases high illuminated. This sequence will continue upon subsevoltage battery consumption and tire tread life, and may quent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists.
affect the vehicle’s handling and stopping ability.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 155
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure
as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety
of reasons, including the installation of replacement or
alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the
TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the
TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more
tires or wheels on your vehicle, to ensure that the
replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS
to continue to function properly.
CAUTION!
CAUTION! (Continued)
equipped on your vehicle. Undesirable system operation or sensor damage may result when using replacement equipment that is not of the same size,
type, and/or style. Aftermarket wheels can cause
sensor damage. Using aftermarket tire sealants may
cause the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
sensor to become inoperable. After using an aftermarket tire sealant it is recommended that you take
your vehicle to an authorized dealership to have your
sensor function checked.
The TPMS has been optimized for the original
equipment tires and wheels. TPMS pressures and
warning have been established for the tire size
(Continued)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
156 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Vehicle Security Indicator Light
Yellow Telltale
Light
What It Means
Vehicle Security Indicator Light
This indicator will illuminate when the Vehicle Theft Alarm system has detected an attempt
was made to break into the vehicle.
Regenerative Brake System (RBS) Indicator Light
Yellow Telltale
Light
What It Means
Regenerative Brake System (RBS) Indicator Light
If the light turns on and remains on while driving, it suggests that there is a potential problem with the Regenerative Brake System (RBS) and the need for system service. See your
authorized dealer as soon as possible.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 157
Anti-Lock Brake (ABS) Indicator Light
Yellow Telltale
Light
What It Means
Anti-Lock Brake (ABS) Indicator Light
This light monitors the Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS). The light will turn on when the ignition switch is placed in the ON/RUN position and may stay on for as long as four seconds.
If the ABS light remains on or turns on while driving, then the Anti-Lock portion of the
brake system is not functioning and service is required. However, the conventional brake
system will continue to operate normally if the brake warning light is not on.
If the ABS light is on, the brake system should be serviced as soon as possible to restore the
benefits of Anti-Lock Brakes. If the ABS light does not turn on when the ignition switch is
placed in the ON/RUN position, have the light inspected by an authorized dealer.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
158 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Rear Defrost Light
Yellow Telltale
Light
What It Means
Rear Defrost Light
This indicator will illuminate when the rear window defroster is on. The rear window defroster automatically turns off after 20 minutes..
CAUTION!
CAUTION! (Continued)
Failure to follow these cautions can cause damage to
the heating elements:
• Use care when washing the inside of the rear
window. Do not use abrasive window cleaners on
the interior surface of the window. Use a soft cloth
and a mild washing solution, wiping parallel to the
heating elements. Labels can be peeled off after
soaking with warm water.
• Do not use scrapers, sharp instruments, or abrasive
window cleaners on the interior surface of the
window.
• Keep all objects a safe distance from the window.
(Continued)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 159
Icy Road Condition Indicator Light
Yellow Telltale
Light
What It Means
Icy Road Condition Indicator Light
This light will illuminate during an icy road condition.
Exterior Bulb Failure Indicator Light
Yellow Telltale
Light
What It Means
Exterior Bulb Failure Indicator Light
This light will illuminate when there is a malfunction in one of the exterior bulbs.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
160 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Green Telltale Indicator Lights
Park/Headlight ON Indicator Light
Green Telltale
Light
What It Means
Park/Headlight ON Indicator Light
This indicator will illuminate when the park lights or headlights are turned on.
Front Fog Indicator Light — If Equipped
Green Telltale
Light
What It Means
Front Fog Indicator Light
This indicator will illuminate when the front fog lights are on.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 161
Turn Signal Indicator Lights
Green Telltale Light
What It Means
Turn Signal Indicator Lights
The instrument cluster arrow will flash independently for the LEFT or RIGHT turn signal as selected, as well as the exterior turn signal lamp(s) (front and rear) as selected when the multifunction lever is moved down (LEFT) or up (RIGHT).
Cruise Control Engaged Indicator Light
Green Telltale
Light
What It Means
Cruise Control Engaged Indicator Light
This light will turn on when the cruise control has been engaged.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
162 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Plugged In Indicator Light
Green Telltale
Light
What It Means
Plugged In Indicator Light
This green indicator will illuminate when the vehicle is plugged in.
White Telltale Indicator Light
Electronic Speed Control ON Indicator Light
White Telltale
Light
What It Means
Electronic Speed Control ON Indicator Light
This light will turn on when the electronic speed control is ON.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 163
Blue Telltale Indicator Light
High Beam Indicator Light
Blue Telltale
Light
What It Means
High Beam Indicator Light
This indicator shows that the high beam headlights are on. Push the multifunction control
lever away from you to switch the headlights to high beam. Pull the lever toward you to
switch the headlights back to low beam. If the driver’s door is open, and the headlights or
park lights are left on, the high beam indicator light will remain illuminated.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
164 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
ELECTRONIC VEHICLE INFORMATION CENTER
(EVIC)
The EVIC consists of the following:
• System Status
The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) features a driver-interactive display that is located in the • Vehicle Information Warning Message Displays
instrument cluster.
• Outside Temperature Display
• Trip Computer Functions
• Tire Pressure Monitoring Display
• Range
EVIC Control Buttons
The EVIC control buttons are located on the right side of
the Instrument Cluster. There are three control buttons
that are used to navigate through the EVIC functions:
• + button
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Display
• – button
• MENU ESC button
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 165
Push and release the + button to scroll upward through
the displayed menu and the related options or to increase
the displayed value. Push and release the – button to
scroll downward through the displayed menu and the
related options or to decrease the value displayed.
+ and – buttons activate different functions according to
the following situations:
• To scroll the menu options upwards or downwards.
• To increase or decrease values during settings.
When opening one of the front doors, the EVIC display
will come on and information such as odometer and
Push and release the MENU ESC button briefly to access clock will be displayed.
the menu and/or go to next screen or to confirm the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
required menu option. Push and hold the MENU ESC Setup Menu
button (approximately one second) to return to the main
The menu comprises a series of functions arranged in a
screen.
cycle. Push and release the + and – buttons to access the
different options and settings (setup).
EVIC Control Buttons
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
166 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
The setup menu can be activated by pushing the MENU 2. Push and release the + or – button (by single pushes)
ESC button. Single pushes on the + or – buttons will
to select the new setting.
scroll through the setup menu options. The menu in3. Briefly push and release the MENU ESC button to
cludes the following functions:
store the new setting and go back to the main menu
• Battery % Display
option previously selected.
• Button Volume
• Stored Warnings
• Tutorial
• Connectivity ID
• Restore Factory Settings
Selecting An Option Of The Main Menu With Submenu:
1. Briefly push and release the MENU ESC button to
display the first submenu option.
2. Push and release the + or – button (by single pushes)
to scroll through all the submenu options.
• Exit Menu
3. Briefly push and release the MENU ESC button to
select the displayed submenu option and to open the
Selecting An Option Of The Main Menu Without
relevant setup menu.
Submenu:
4. Push and release the + or – button (by single pushes)
1. Briefly push and release the MENU ESC button to
to select the new setting for this submenu option.
select the main menu option to set.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 167
5. Briefly push and release the MENU ESC button to
store the new setting and go back to the previously
selected submenu option.
6. Push and hold the MENU ESC button to return to the
main menu (short hold) or the main screen (longer
hold).
4
Trip Computer
The Trip Computer is located in the instrument cluster.
The Trip Computer displays trip information such as:
average speed, distance traveled, average energy, time
traveled, motor power, and tire pressure.
Trip Button
• A short button push scrolls through the user-selectable
information.
The TRIP button is located on the right steering column
stalk.
• A long button push resets.
Trip Button
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
168 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
The User-Selectable options are:
Trip Functions
• Motor Power (Kilowatts)
Both trip functions are resettable (reset — start of new
trip).
• Trip A
• Trip B
• Tire Pressure
New Trip
To reset:
• Push and hold the TRIP button manually.
“Trip A” can be used to display the figures relating to:
• distance
• avg. energy
• avg. speed
• elapsed time (driving time)
“Trip B” can be used to display the figures relating to:
• When the “Trip Distance” reaches 9999.9 miles/ • distance
kilometers or when the “Elapsed Time” reaches 29.59
(29 hours and 59 minutes) the system will reset auto- • avg. energy
matically.
• avg. speed
• elapsed time (driving time)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 169
Values Displayed
Distance Traveled
Range
This value shows the distance covered since the last reset.
This indicates the distance which may be travelled with Average Speed
the remaining battery charge, assuming that driving
This value shows the vehicle’s average speed as a funcconditions will not change. The message “----” will tion of the overall time elapsed since the last reset.
appear when the system is initializing.
Elapsed Time
NOTE: The range depends on several factors: driving
style, type of route (freeway, residential, mountain roads, This value shows the time elapsed since the last reset.
etc.), conditions of use of the car (load, tire pressure, etc.).
UCONNECT RADIOS
Trip planning must take into account the above notes.
For detailed information about your Uconnect radio,
refer to your Uconnect Supplement Manual.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
170 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
iPod/USB/MEDIA PLAYER CONTROL — IF
EQUIPPED
This feature allows an iPod or external USB device to be
plugged into the USB or AUX port, located in the center
console.
USB/AUX Port
1 — Auxiliary Cable Jack
2 — USB Connector
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 171
UCONNECT SETTINGS
The Uconnect system uses a combination of buttons on
the touchscreen and buttons on the faceplate located on
the center of the instrument panel that allow you to
access and change the customer programmable features.
Many features can vary by vehicle.
4
Uconnect 5.0 Buttons On The Touchscreen And Buttons
On The Faceplate
1 — Uconnect Buttons On The Touchscreen
2 — Uconnect Buttons On The Faceplate
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
172 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Buttons On The Faceplate
Buttons On The Touchscreen
Buttons on the faceplate are located below, and beside the
Uconnect system in the center of the instrument panel. In
addition, there is a Scroll/Enter control knob located on
the right side. Turn the control knob to scroll through
menus and change settings (i.e., 30, 60, 90), push the
center of the control knob one or more times to select or
change a setting (i.e., ON, OFF).
Buttons on the touchscreen are accessible on the
Uconnect touchscreen.
Customer Programmable Features — Uconnect
5.0 Settings
Push the Settings
button on the faceplate, to display
the settings menu screen. In this mode the Uconnect
system allows you to access programmable feature
Your Uconnect system may also have Display Off and
settings.
back arrow buttons on the faceplate.
NOTE: Only one touchscreen area may be selected at a
Push the Display Off button on the faceplate to turn off
time.
the Uconnect screen. Push the Display Off button on the
When making a selection, press the button on the touchfaceplate a second time to turn the screen on.
screen to enter the desired mode. Once in the desired
Push the Back Arrow button on the faceplate to exit out
mode, press and release the preferred setting and make
of a Menu or certain option on the Uconnect system.
your selection. Once the setting is complete, either press
the Back Arrow button on the touchscreen or the Back
button on the faceplate to return to the previous menu or
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 173
press the “X” button on the touchscreen to close out of When the desired charging schedule has been set up,
the settings screen. Pressing the Up or Down Arrow press the “X” button on the touchscreen to save the
buttons on the right side of the screen will allow you to schedule and close the settings menu.
toggle up or down through the available settings.
NOTE: Refer to “Electric System Operation” for further
NOTE: All settings should be changed with the ignition information regarding charging your vehicle.
in the “ AVV/ACC ” position.
Display
Charging Schedule
After pressing the “Display” button on the touchscreen
To set up a charging schedule, press the “More” or the following settings will be available.
“Settings” button on the touchscreen.
• Display Mode
Press the “Enable Schedule” box on the touchscreen. A When in this display you may select the “Auto” or
check mark will appear in the box indicating that sched- “Manual” display settings. To change Mode status, press
uling has been turned on. Continue setting up the and release the “Auto” or “Manual” button on the
schedule picking from the following menus:
touchscreen.
• Weekdays or Weekends
• Start and End Times
• Brightness
When in this display, you may select the overall screen
brightness with the headlights on or off. Adjust the
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
174 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
brightness with the “+” and “–” setting buttons on the Units
touchscreen or by selecting any point on the scale be- After pressing the “Units” button on the touchscreen you
tween the “+” and “–” buttons on the touchscreen.
may select each unit of measure independently displayed
in the Electronic Vehicle Information System (EVIC) or
• Language
Driver Information Display (DID). The following selectWhen in this display, you may select one of multiple
able units of measure are listed below:
languages (English/Español/Français) for all display nomenclature, including the trip functions and the naviga- • US
tion system (if equipped). Press the “Language” button Changes the EVIC/DID to US units of measure.
on the touchscreen, then press the desired language
• Metric
button on the touchscreen.
Changes the EVIC/DID to Metric units of measure.
• Touchscreen Beep
When in this display, you may turn on or shut off the • Custom
sound heard when a touchscreen button is pressed. Press • Temperature
Select from: “°C,” or “°F.”
the “Touchscreen Beep” button on the touchscreen then
“On” or “Off.”
• Pressure
Select from: “psi” or “kPa.”
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 175
Voice
Clock & Date
After pressing the “Voice” button on the touchscreen the After pressing the “Clock & Date” button on the touchfollowing settings will be available:
screen the following settings will be available:
• Voice Response Length
• Set Time and Format
When in this display, you may change the Voice Response Length settings. To change the Voice Response
Length, press the “Voice Response Length” button on the
touchscreen and select from “Brief” or “Long.”
When in this display, you may set the time and format
manually. Press the “Set Time and Format” button then
choose from a 12 hour or 24 hour format. Press the
corresponding arrow above and below the current time
to adjust, then select “AM” or “PM.”
• Show Command List
When in this display, you may change the Show Command List settings. To change the Show Command List
settings, press the “Show Command List” button on the
touchscreen and select from “Always,” “With Help” or
“Never.”
• Show Time Status
When in this display, you may turn on or shut off the
digital clock in the status bar. To change the Show Time
Status setting press the “Show Time Status” button on the
touchscreen and select from “ON” or “OFF.”
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
176 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
• Set Date
and operating information. To make your selection, press
the “Hill Start Assist” button on the touchscreen and
When in this display, you may set the date manually.
select “On” or “Off.” Press the back arrow button on the
Press the “Set Date” button on the touchscreen then press
touchscreen to return to the previous menu.
the corresponding arrows above and below the current
Lights
date to adjust.
• Sync Time — If Equipped
After pressing the “Lights” button on the touchscreen the
following settings will be available.
When in this display, you may sync the time with GPS.
Press the “Sync Time” button on the touchscreen and • Daytime Running Lights
select from “ON” or “OFF.”
When this feature is selected, the headlights will turn on
while the engine is running. To make your selection,
Safety/Assistance
press the “Daytime Running Lights” button on the touchAfter pressing the “Safety/Assistance” button on the
screen, then choose “On” or “Off.” The button will
touchscreen the following setting will be available:
highlight indicating that the setting has been selected.
• Hill Start Assist
Doors & Locks
When this feature is selected, the Hill Start Assist (HSA)
After pressing the “Doors & Locks” button on the touchsystem is active. Refer to “Electronic Brake Control
screen the following setting will be available.
System” in “Starting And Operating” for system function
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 177
• Auto Door Locks
• Radio Off Delay
When this feature is selected, all doors will lock automatically when the vehicle reaches a speed of 12 mph
(20 km/h). To make your selection, press the “Auto Door
Locks” button on the touchscreen and select from “On”
or “Off.”
When this feature is selected, the radio will stay on for a
preset time after the ignition key is turned to STOP/OFF.
To change the Radio Off Delay status, press the “0 MIN”
or “20 MIN” button on the touchscreen to select your
desired time interval.
• Remote Door Unlock/Door Unlock
• Radio Off With Door — If Equipped
When “Driver” is selected, only the driver’s door will
unlock on the first push of the Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) transmitter UNLOCK button, you must push the
RKE transmitter UNLOCK button twice to unlock the
passenger’s doors. When “All” is selected, all of the
doors will unlock on the first press of the RKE transmitter
UNLOCK button.
When this feature is selected, the radio will turn off when
a door is opened. To make your selection, select from
“On” or “Off” on the touchscreen.
Engine Off Options
Audio
After pressing the “Audio” button on the touchscreen the
following settings will be available:
• Equalizer
After pressing the “Engine Off Options” button on the When in this display you may adjust the Bass, Mid and
Treble settings. Adjust the settings with the “+” and “–”
touchscreen the following settings will be available.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
178 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
setting buttons on the touchscreen or by selecting any Phone/Bluetooth
point on the scale between the “+” and “–” buttons on the After pressing the “Phone/Bluetooth” button on the
touchscreen.
touchscreen the following settings will be available:
NOTE: Bass/Mid/Treble allow you to simply slide your • Paired Phones
finger up or down to change the setting as well as press
This feature shows which phones are paired to the
directly on the desired setting.
Phone/Bluetooth system. For further information, refer
• Balance
to the Uconnect Supplement Manual.
When in this display you may adjust the Balance settings. SiriusXM Setup — If Equipped
• Auto-On Radio
After pressing the “SiriusXM Setup” button on the touchThe Radio automatically turns on when vehicle is in run screen, the following settings will be available:
or will recall whether it was on or off at last ignition off. • Tune Start
To make your selection, push the “Settings” button, then
Tune Start begins playing the current song from the
“Audio,” then “Auto-On Radio.”
beginning when you tune to a music channel using one of
the twelve presets, so you can enjoy the complete song.
This feature occurs the first time the preset is selected
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 179
during that current song. Tune Start works in the background, so you will not even realize it’s on, except that
you will miss the experience of joining your favorite song
with only a few seconds left to play. To make your
selection, press the “Tune Start” button on the touchscreen, select “On” or “Off.”
• Channel Skip
SiriusXM can be programmed to designate a group of
channels that are the most desirable to listen to or to
exclude undesirable channels while scanning. To make
your selection, press the “Channel Skip” button on the
touchscreen, select the channels you would like to skip
followed by pressing the back arrow button on the
touchscreen.
• Subscription Information
services, it will be necessary to access the information on
the Subscription Information screen to re-subscribe.
Press the “Subscription Info” button on the touchscreen
to access the Subscription Information screen.
Write down the SIRIUS ID numbers for your receiver. To
reactivate your service, either call the number listed on
the screen or visit the provider online.
NOTE: SiriusXM Travel Link is a separate subscription
and is available for U.S. residents only.
Restore Settings
After pressing the “Restore Settings” button on the
touchscreen the following settings will be available:
• Restore Settings
New vehicle purchasers or lessees will receive a free When this feature is selected it will reset the Display,
limited time subscription to SiriusXM Satellite Radio Clock, Audio, and Radio Settings to their default settings.
with your radio. Following the expiration of the free
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
180 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
To restore the settings to their default setting, press the
Restore Settings button. A pop-up will appear asking
⬙Are you sure you want to reset your settings to default?”
select “Yes” to restore, or “No” to exit. Once the settings
are restored, a pop up appears stating ⬙settings reset to
default.⬙
Clear Personal Data
UCONNECT 5.0 VOICE RECOGNITION QUICK
TIPS
Introducing Uconnect
Start using Uconnect Voice Recognition with these helpful quick tips. It provides the key Voice Commands and
tips you need to know to control your Uconnect 5.0
system.
After pressing the “Clear Personal Data Settings” button
Key Features:
on the touchscreen the following settings will be avail• 5.0” Full Color Touchscreen Display
able:
• Clear Personal Data
• Bluetooth With Integrated Voice Control
When this feature is selected it will remove personal data • GPS Navigation (If Equipped)
including Bluetooth devices and presets. To remove
personal information, press the “Clear Personal Data”
button and a pop-up will appear asking ⬙Are you sure
you want to clear all personal data?” select “Yes” or “No”
to exit. Once the data has been cleared, a pop up appears
stating ⬙Personal data cleared”.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 181
2. Reduce background noise. Wind and passenger conversations are examples of noise that may impact
recognition.
3. Speak clearly at a normal pace and volume while
facing straight ahead. The microphone is positioned
on the rearview mirror and aimed at the driver.
4. Each time you give a Voice Command, you must first
push either the VR or PHONE button, wait until after
the beep, then say your Voice Command.
Uconnect 5.0
Get Started
5. You can interrupt the help message or system prompts
by pushing the VR or PHONE button and saying a
Voice Command from current category.
All you need to control your Uconnect system with your
1. Visit UconnectPhone.com to check mobile device and
voice are the buttons on your steering wheel.
feature compatibility and to find phone pairing instructions.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
182 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Basic Voice Commands
The basic Voice Commands below can be given at any
point while using your Uconnect system.
Push the VR button
. After the beep, sayѧ
• Cancel to stop a current voice session
• Help to hear a list of suggested Voice Commands
• Repeat to listen to the system prompts again
Notice the visual cues that inform you of your voice
recognition system’s status. Cues appear on the touchscreen.
VR And Phone Buttons
1 — Push to MUTE
2 — Push To Initiate Or To Answer A Phone Call, Send Or Receive A Text
3 — Push To End Call
4 — Push To Begin Radio Or Media Functions
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 183
Radio
Use your voice to quickly get to the AM, FM or SiriusXM
Satellite Radio stations you would like to hear. (Subscription or included SiriusXM Satellite Radio trial required.)
Push the VR button
. After the beep, sayѧ
• Tune to ninety-five-point-five FM
• Tune to Satellite Channel Hits 1
Uconnect 5.0 VR
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
184 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
TIP: At any time, if you are not sure of what to say or Media
want to learn a Voice Command, push the VR button Uconnect offers connections via USB, Bluetooth and
and say “Help.” The system will provide you with
Auxiliary ports (If Equipped). Voice operation is only
a list of commands.
available for connected USB and iPod devices.
. After the beep, say one of the
Push the VR button
following commands and follow the prompts to
switch your media source or choose an artist.
• Change source to Bluetooth
• Change source to iPod
• Change source to USB
• Play artist Beethoven; Play album Greatest Hits; Play
song Moonlight Sonata; Play genre Classical
Uconnect 5.0 Radio
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 185
TIP: Press the “Browse” button on the touchscreen to see
all of the music on your iPod or USB device. Your Voice
Command must match exactly how the artist, album,
song and genre information is displayed.
Voice Text Reply
Uconnect will announce incoming text messages. Push
and say Listen. (Must have
the PHONE button
compatible mobile phone paired to Uconnect system.)
1. Once an incoming text message is read to you, push
. After the beep, say... “Rethe PHONE button
ply.”
2. Listen to the Uconnect prompts. After the beep, repeat
one of the pre-defined messages and follow the system
prompts.
PRE-DEFINED VOICE TEXT REPLY RESPONSES
Yes.
Stuck in traffic.
See you later.
No.
Start without
I’ll be late.
me.
Uconnect 5.0 Media
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
186 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
PRE-DEFINED VOICE TEXT REPLY RESPONSES
Okay.
Where are you? I will be minutes
Call me.
Are you there
late.
yet?
I’ll call you
I need direcSee you in
later.
tions.
of
minutes.
I’m on my way.
Can’t talk right
now.
I’m lost.
Thanks.
by relocating the mobile phone antenna. This condition is
not harmful to the radio. If your radio performance does
not satisfactorily “clear” by the repositioning of the
antenna, it is recommended that the radio volume be
turned down or off during mobile phone operation.
Harmful Interference Statement
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules and
RSS 210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the
following conditions:
TIP: Your mobile phone must have the full implementa• This device may not cause harmful interference.
tion of the Message Access Profile (MAP) to take advantage of this feature. For details about MAP, visit • This device must accept any interference received,
UconnectPhone.com. Apple iPhone iOS6 or later supincluding interference that may cause undesired opports reading incoming text messages only.
eration.
Radio Operation And Mobile Phones
NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressly approved
Under certain conditions, the mobile phone being on in by the party responsible for compliance could void the
your vehicle can cause erratic or noisy performance from user’s authority to operate the equipment.
your radio. This condition may be lessened or eliminated
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 187
Additional Information
STEERING WHEEL AUDIO CONTROLS
© 2015 FCA US LLC. All rights reserved. Mopar and The remote sound system controls are located on the rear
Uconnect are registered trademarks and Mopar Owner surface of the steering wheel. Reach behind the wheel to
Connect is a trademark of FCA US LLC. Android is a access the switches.
trademark of Google Inc. SiriusXM and all related marks
and logos are trademarks of SiriusXM Radio Inc.
Uconnect System Support:
• U.S. residents call 1-877-855-8400 (24 hours a day 7
days a week) or visit DriveUconnect.com
• Canadian residents call 1-800-465-2001 (English) or
1-800-387-9983 (French) or visit DriveUconnect.ca
• Mon. – Fri., 8:00 am – 8:00 pm, ET
• Sat., 9:00 am – 5:00 pm, ET
• Sun., Closed
Remote Sound System Controls (Back View Of Steering
Wheel)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
188 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
The right-hand control is a rocker-type switch with a
pushbutton in the center and controls the volume and
mode of the sound system. Pushing the top of the rocker
switch will increase the volume, and pushing the bottom
of the rocker switch will decrease the volume.
Radio Operation
Pushing the top of the switch will “Seek” up for the next
listenable station and pushing the bottom of the switch
will “Seek” down for the next listenable station.
The button located in the center of the left-hand control
Pushing the center button will make the radio switch will tune to the next preset station that you have probetween the various modes available (AM/FM/SAT/ grammed in the radio preset button.
AUX/Media Player, etc.) and can also be used to select/
enter an item while scrolling through menu.
RADIO OPERATION AND MOBILE PHONES
The left-hand control is a rocker-type switch with a Under certain conditions, the mobile phone being on in
pushbutton in the center. The function of the left-hand your vehicle can cause erratic or noisy performance from
control is different depending on which mode you are in. your radio. This condition may be lessened or eliminated
by relocating the mobile phone antenna. This condition is
The following describes the left-hand control operation in
not harmful to the radio. If your radio performance does
each mode.
not satisfactorily “clear” by the repositioning of the
antenna, it is recommended that the radio volume be
turned down or off during mobile phone operation.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 189
TELEMATICS MODEM
• Email and SMS notifications
Your vehicle is equipped with a 3G CDMA cellular NOTE: This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC.
modem to connect the vehicle with your device to Operation is subject to the following conditions:
provide the following features:
• This device may not cause harmful interference.
• Range and State of Charge Information
• This device must accept any interference received,
• Configure Scheduled Charging Profile
including interference that may cause undesired operation.
• Average and total energy used
• Charge station location and availability on in vehicle Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the
party responsible for compliance could void the user’s
NAV map
authority to operate the equipment.
• Send navigation destination to vehicle from within
CLIMATE CONTROLS
Mobile App
The air conditioning and heating system is designed to
• Remote Door Lock/Unlock
make you comfortable in all types of weather.
• Remote Horn and Lights Activation
• Pre-conditioning of interior temperature
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
190 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Automatic Temperature Control (ATC)
• The Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) allows the
occupant to select a comfort settings.
• The system provides set-and-forget operation for optimum comfort and convenience.
• The system can be controlled manually, if desired.
The ATC system automatically maintains the interior
comfort level desired by the occupant.
Automatic Temperature Controls
1. AUTO Temperature Control (ATC) Button
Controls airflow, temperature, distribution, and air recirculation automatically. Push and release to select. Performing this function will cause the ATC to switch
between manual mode and automatic modes. Refer to
“Automatic Operation” for more information.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 191
are selected. This allows the front occupants to control
the volume of air circulated in the vehicle and cancel the
Push and release to change the current Air Conditioning
AUTO mode.
(A/C) setting. Performing this function will cause the
The operator can also select the direction of the airflow
ATC to switch into manual mode.
by selecting one of the following positions.
3. Temperature Control Up Button
5. Mix Mode
Provides temperature up control. Push the button for
Air is directed through the floor, defrost, and side
warmer temperature settings.
window demister outlets. This setting works best
4. Blower Control Up/Down Buttons
in cold or snowy conditions that require extra heat to the
There are 12 fixed blower speeds. The blower control windshield. This setting is good for maintaining comfort
up/down buttons regulate the amount of air forced while reducing moisture on the windshield. Performing
through the system in any mode you select. The blower this function will cause the ATC to switch into manual
speed increases as you push, or hold, the blower control mode.
up button and decreases when you push, or hold, the 6. Front Defrost
blower control down button.
Push and release to change the current airflow
The blower fan speed may be set to any fixed speed by
setting to Defrost mode. The indicator illuminates
pushing the blower control up or down buttons. The fan
when
this
feature is ON. Air comes from the windshield
will now operate at a fixed speed until additional speeds
2. A/C Button
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
192 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
and side window demist outlets. When the defrost but- NOTE: The center instrument panel outlets can be aimed
ton is selected, the blower level will increase. Use Defrost so that they are directed toward the rear seat passengers
mode with maximum temperature settings for best wind- for maximum airflow to the rear.
shield and side window defrosting and defogging. Per9. Bi-Level
forming this function will cause the ATC to switch into
Air is directed through the panel and floor outlets.
manual mode. If the front defrost mode is turned off the
Press and release the Panel mode button and Floor
climate system will return the previous setting.
mode button to enter Bi-Level mode, the indicators
7. Floor Mode
illuminate when ON. Performing this function will cause
Air is directed through the floor outlets with a the ATC to switch into manual mode.
small amount flowing through the defrost and 10. Temperature Control Down Button
side window demister outlets. Performing this function
Provides temperature down control. Push the button for
will cause the ATC to switch into manual mode.
cooler temperature settings.
8. Panel Mode
NOTE: If the temperature is lowered until ⬙Lo⬙ is disAir is directed through the outlets in the instruplayed, all high voltage Heating, Ventilation, and Air
ment panel. These outlets can be adjusted to direct
Conditioning (HVAC) systems are deactivated and amairflow. Performing this function will cause the ATC to
bient air is circulated according to the Heating, Ventilaswitch into manual mode.
tion, and Air Conditioning (HVAC) control settings.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 193
outlets. If Economy mode is desired, push the A/C
button to turn off the A/C mode in the ATC display and
Push and release to turn the Climate Control ON or OFF.
deactivate the A/C system.
12. Recirculation Control Button
NOTE:
Push and release to change the current setting. The
• If the system is in Mix or Defrost Mode, the A/C can
indicator illuminates when ON.
be turned off, but the A/C system shall remain active
NOTE: When in Defrost mode, the Recirculation button
to prevent fogging of the windows.
will flash if pushed. This indicates that you can not
• If fog or mist appears on the windshield or side glass,
proceed to this mode due to fogging risk.
select Defrost mode and adjust blower speed if
Climate Control Functions
needed.
11. Climate Control ON/OFF Button
Air Conditioning (A/C)
Recirculation Control
The Air Conditioning (A/C) button allows the operator
to manually activate or deactivate the air conditioning
system. When in A/C mode with the ATC set to a cool
temperature, dehumidified air flows through the air
When outside air contains smoke, odors, or high humidity, or if rapid cooling is desired, you may wish to
recirculate interior air by pushing the RECIRCULATION
control button. Recirculation mode should only be used
temporarily. The recirculation LED will illuminate when
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
194 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
this button is selected. Push the button a second time to 2. Next, adjust the temperature you would like the
system to maintain by adjusting the temperature conturn off the Recirculation mode LED and allow outside
trol buttons. Once the desired temperature is disair into the vehicle.
played, the system will achieve and automatically
NOTE: In cold weather, use of Recirculation mode may
maintain that comfort level.
lead to excessive window fogging. The recirculation
feature may be unavailable (indicator light shall blink) if 3. When the system is set up for your comfort level, it is
not necessary to change the settings. You will expericonditions exist that could create fogging on the inside of
ence the greatest efficiency by simply allowing the
the windshield. On systems with Manual Climate Consystem to function automatically.
trols, the Recirculation mode is not allowed in Defrost
mode to improve window clearing operation. RecirculaNOTE:
tion will be disabled automatically if this mode is selected. Attempting to use Recirculation while in this • It is not necessary to move the temperature settings for
cold or hot vehicles. The system automatically adjusts
mode will cause the LED in the control button to blink
the temperature, mode and fan speed to provide
and then turn off.
comfort as quickly as possible.
Automatic Operation
• The temperature can be displayed in U.S. or Metric
1. Push the AUTO button on the Automatic Temperature
units by selecting the US/M customer-programmable
Control (ATC) Panel, the indicator will illuminate
when on.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 195
feature. Refer to the “Electronic Vehicle Information Operating Tips
Center (EVIC) — Customer-Programmable Features”
NOTE: Refer to the chart at the end of this section for
in this section of the manual.
suggested control settings for various weather condiManual Operation
tions.
The system allows for manual selection of blower speed, Window Fogging
air distribution mode, A/C status and recirculation conWindows will fog on the inside when the humidity inside
trol.
the vehicle is high. This often occurs in mild or cool
The blower fan speed can be set to any fixed speed by temperatures when it’s rainy or humid. In most cases,
adjusting the blower control. The fan will now operate at turning the air conditioning (pressing the A/C button) on
a fixed speed until additional speeds are selected. This will clear the fog. Adjust the temperature control, air
allows the front occupants to control the volume of air direction, and blower speed to maintain comfort.
circulated in the vehicle and cancel the Auto mode.
As the temperature gets colder, it may be necessary to
The operator can also select the direction of the airflow direct air onto the windshield. Adjust the temperature
by selecting one of the available mode settings. A/C control and blower speed to maintain comfort. Higher
operation and Recirculation control can also be manually blower speeds will reduce fogging. Interior fogging on
the windshield can be quickly removed by selecting the
selected in Manual operation.
Defrost mode.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
4
196 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Regular cleaning of the inside of the windows with a
non-filming cleaning solution (vinegar and water works
very well) will help prevent contaminates (cigarette
smoke, perfumes, etc.) from sticking to the windows.
Contaminates increase the rate of window fogging.
Winter Operation
When operating the system during the winter months,
make sure the air intake, located directly in front of the
windshield, is free of ice, slush, snow, or other obstructions.
NOTE: Automatic Temperature Controls (ATC) will au- Vacation Storage
tomatically adjust the climate control settings to reduce
or eliminate window fogging on the front windshield. Anytime you store your vehicle, or keep it out of service
(i.e., vacation) for two weeks or more, run the air
When this occurs, recirculation will be unavailable.
conditioning system at idle for about five minutes in the
Summer Operation
fresh air using the high blower setting. This will ensure
Your air conditioning system is also equipped with an adequate system lubrication to minimize the possibility
automatic recirculation system. When the system senses of compressor damage when the air conditioning system
a heavy load or high heat conditions, it may use Recir- is started again.
culation A/C mode to provide additional comfort while
in automatic mode.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 197
Operating Tips Chart
4
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING
CONTENTS
䡵 STARTING PROCEDURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202 䡵 DRIVING THROUGH WATER . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
▫ Single-Speed Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202
▫ Flowing/Rising Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
▫ Normal Starting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202
▫ Shallow Standing Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
䡵 SINGLE–SPEED TRANSMISSION . . . . . . . . . . .203 䡵 POWER STEERING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212
▫ Key Ignition Park Interlock. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205 䡵 PARKING BRAKE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
▫ Gear Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206 䡵 BRAKE SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
▫ Auto Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .208 䡵 ELECTRONIC BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM . . . .216
䡵 DRIVING ON SLIPPERY SURFACES . . . . . . . . .210
▫ Four-Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) . . .216
▫ Acceleration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210
▫ Brake Assist System (BAS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
▫ Traction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210
▫ Traction Control System (TCS) . . . . . . . . . . . .218
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
200 STARTING AND OPERATING
▫ Electronic Stability Control (ESC) . . . . . . . . . .219
▫ Radial Ply Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237
▫ ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light
And ESC OFF Indicator Light . . . . . . . . . . . .221
▫ Tire Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238
▫ Regenerative Braking System (RBS) . . . . . . . . .222
䡵 TIRE SAFETY INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
▫ Tire Markings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
▫ Tire Identification Number (TIN). . . . . . . . . . .227
▫ Tire Terminology And Definitions . . . . . . . . . .229
▫ Tire Loading And Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . .230
䡵 TIRES — GENERAL INFORMATION . . . . . . . .234
▫ Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
▫ Run Flat Tires — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
▫ Spare Tires — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
▫ Tire Spinning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243
▫ Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243
▫ Life Of Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244
▫ Replacement Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
䡵 TIRE CHAINS (TRACTION DEVICES) . . . . . . . .247
䡵 TIRE ROTATION RECOMMENDATIONS . . . . .248
▫ Tire Inflation Pressures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235
䡵 PREMIUM TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR
SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .249
▫ Tire Pressures For High Speed Operation . . . .237
▫ Premium TPM System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 201
▫ Tire Pressure Monitoring Low Pressure
Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
▫ Towing This Vehicle Behind Another Vehicle . .256
▫ TPMS Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253
䡵 EXTENDING YOUR DRIVING RANGE PER
CHARGE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
▫ Driver Behavior Gauge. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
䡵 TRAILER TOWING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
▫ Range Projection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
䡵 RECREATIONAL TOWING (BEHIND
MOTORHOME, ETC.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
202 STARTING AND OPERATING
STARTING PROCEDURES
Single-Speed Transmission
Before starting your vehicle, adjust your seat, adjust both The transmission must be in the PARK or NEUTRAL
inside and outside mirrors, and fasten your seat belts.
position before you can start the vehicle. Apply the
brakes when selecting a transmission gear from Park.
WARNING!
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle.
• Allowing children to be in a vehicle unattended is
dangerous for a number of reasons. A child or
others could be seriously or fatally injured. Children should be warned not to touch the parking
brake, brake pedal or the shift lever.
• Do not leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle (or
in a location accessible to children). A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
NOTE: You must press the brake pedal before selecting
a transmission gear.
Normal Starting
Turn the key to the START position while your vehicle is
in PARK. When the ignition key is turned to the START
and then released to the RUN position, a chime will
sound and the “READY” indicator in the EVIC will
illuminate to indicate the 500e’s Electric Drive System has
started. When the “READY” indicator is illuminated
your 500e is ready to be driven.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 203
• If the “READY” indicator fails to illuminate after you
have followed the normal starting procedure contact
your authorized dealer.
SINGLE–SPEED TRANSMISSION
Your 500e uses a Single-Speed Transmission to direct the
output from the electric motor. The single-speed transmission is operated using push-buttons instead of a
traditional shift lever.
“READY” Indicator
NOTE:
• If the key is held in the START position for more than
10 seconds “READY” mode will not be achieved.
Return the key to OFF position, and then back to the
START position and hold for less than 10 seconds to
achieve “READY”.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
204 STARTING AND OPERATING
The push-buttons are located on the lower instrument
panel.
CAUTION!
Damage to the transmission may occur if the following precautions are not observed:
• Place the transmission into PARK only after the
vehicle has come to a complete stop.
• Place the transmission into or out of REVERSE
only after the vehicle has come to a complete stop.
• Before placing the transmission into any range
make sure your foot is firmly pressing the brake
pedal.
NOTE:
Single-Speed Transmission Push-Buttons
• You must press and hold the brake pedal while
shifting out of PARK.
• If all push-button LEDs are on when the key is ON, see
your authorized dealer.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 205
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
• Only place the transmission into gear when your
foot is firmly pressing the brake pedal.
• Unintended movement of a vehicle could injure
those in or near the vehicle. As with all vehicles,
you should never exit a vehicle while the vehicle is
in “READY” mode. Before exiting a vehicle, always
apply the parking brake, shift the transmission
into PARK, and remove the ignition key. Once the
key is removed, the transmission is locked in
PARK, securing the vehicle against unwanted
movement.
• When leaving the vehicle, always remove the ignition key and lock your vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. Allowing children to
be in a vehicle unattended is dangerous for a
number of reasons. A child or others could be
seriously or fatally injured. Children should be
warned not to touch the parking brake, brake pedal
or the transmission range buttons.
• Do not leave the ignition key in or near the vehicle
(or in a location accessible to children). A child
could operate power windows, other controls, or
move the vehicle.
Key Ignition Park Interlock
This vehicle is equipped with a Key Ignition Park Interlock which requires the transmission to be in PARK
before the ignition switch can be turned to the OFF
position. The key can only be removed from the ignition
when the ignition is in the OFF position, and once
removed, the transmission is locked in PARK.
(Continued)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
206 STARTING AND OPERATING
When parking on a hill, apply the parking brake before
placing the transmission into PARK. As an added precaution, turn the front wheels toward the curb on a
downhill grade and away from the curb on an uphill
grade.
Gear Ranges
Push the desired push button to shift into gear.
NOTE:
• The brake pedal must be depressed to select a transmission gear.
NOTE: Refer to the transmission range position displayed on the EVIC and verify that it indicates the PARK
• After selecting any gear, wait a moment to allow the
position.
selected gear to engage before accelerating.
PARK (P)
WARNING!
The PARK selection supplements the parking brake by
locking the transmission. The vehicle can be started in
this range. Never attempt to use PARK while the vehicle
is in motion. Apply the parking brake when leaving the
vehicle in this PARK.
When parking on a level surface, you may place the
transmission into PARK first, and then apply the parking
brake.
• Never use the PARK position as a substitute for the
parking brake. Always apply the parking brake
fully when parked to guard against vehicle movement and possible injury or damage.
• Your vehicle could move and injure you and others
if it is not in PARK. Make sure the transmission is
in PARK before leaving the vehicle.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 207
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• It is dangerous to shift out of PARK or NEUTRAL
if your foot is not firmly pressing the brake pedal.
The vehicle could accelerate quickly forward or in
reverse. You could lose control of the vehicle and
hit someone or something. Only shift the transmission into gear when your foot is firmly pressing the
brake pedal.
• Unintended movement of a vehicle could injure
those in or near the vehicle. As with all vehicles,
you should never exit a vehicle while the vehicle is
in “ready mode”. Before exiting a vehicle, always
apply the parking brake, shift the transmission
into PARK, and remove the ignition key. Once the
key is removed, the transmission is locked in
PARK, securing the vehicle against unwanted
movement.
• When leaving the vehicle, always remove the ignition key and lock your vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. Allowing children to
be in a vehicle unattended is dangerous for a
number of reasons. A child or others could be
seriously or fatally injured. Children should be
warned not to touch the parking brake, brake pedal
or the transmission range buttons.
• Do not leave the ignition key in or near the vehicle
(or in a location accessible to children). A child
could operate power windows, other controls, or
move the vehicle.
(Continued)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
208 STARTING AND OPERATING
REVERSE (R)
CAUTION!
This gear is for moving the vehicle backward. Shift into
REVERSE only after the vehicle has come to a complete
stop.
NEUTRAL (N)
The vehicle may be started in this gear. Apply the
parking brake and place the transmission into PARK if
you must leave the vehicle.
Towing the vehicle, coasting, or driving for any other
reason with the transmission in NEUTRAL can cause
severe transmission damage. Refer to “Recreational
Towing” in “Starting And Operating” and “Towing A
Disabled Vehicle” in “What To Do In Emergencies”
for further information.
DRIVE (D)
Use this gear for all city and highway driving.
WARNING!
Do not coast in NEUTRAL and never turn off the
ignition to coast down a hill. These are unsafe
practices that limit your response to changing traffic
or road conditions. You might lose control of the
vehicle and have a collision.
Auto Park
The Auto Park feature automatically places the transmission into PARK if there is any indication that the driver
may leave the vehicle while the transmission is in D
(DRIVE), N (NEUTRAL) or R (REVERSE).
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 209
Auto Park is enabled under the following conditions:
Mode Of Operation With Key ON:
• Key On (12 Volt ON and High Voltage OFF) or READY Auto Park will be engaged when the transmission is in
DRIVE, NEUTRAL or REVERSE and the following conmode (12 Volt ON and High Voltage ON).
ditions are detected:
• Vehicle speed is below 2 mph (3 km/h).
• Seat Belt is unlatched
NOTE:
• Brake pedal is released
• Auto Park is enabled (only once) at the beginning of
each key cycle and is re-enabled each time the vehicle • Driver’s door is ajar
speed exceeds 8 mph (13 km/h).
• Vehicle speed is less than 2 mph (3 km/h)
• Auto Park is disabled above 2 mph (3 km/h) and Mode Of Operation With Key OFF:
transmission range will be maintained.
Auto Park will be engaged when the transmission is in
DRIVE, NEUTRAL or REVERSE and the vehicle speed is
The instrument cluster will display an Auto Shift To Park less than 2 mph (3 km/h).
message and chime once when Auto Park is activated.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
210 STARTING AND OPERATING
DRIVING ON SLIPPERY SURFACES
Traction
Acceleration
When driving on wet or slushy roads, it is possible for a
wedge of water to build up between the tire and road
surface. This is hydroplaning and may cause partial or
complete loss of vehicle control and stopping ability. To
reduce this possibility, the following precautions should
be observed:
Rapid acceleration on snow covered, wet, or other slippery surfaces may cause the driving wheels to pull
erratically to the right or left. This phenomenon occurs
when there is a difference in the surface traction under
the front (driving) wheels.
1. Slow down during rainstorms or when the roads are
slushy.
WARNING!
Rapid acceleration on slippery surfaces is dangerous.
Unequal traction can cause sudden pulling of the
front wheels. You could lose control of the vehicle
and possibly have a collision. Accelerate slowly and
carefully whenever there is likely to be poor traction
(ice, snow, wet, mud, loose sand, etc.).
2. Slow down if the road has standing water or puddles.
3. Replace the tires when tread wear indicators first
become visible.
4. Keep tires properly inflated.
5. Maintain sufficient distance between your vehicle and
the vehicle in front of you to avoid a collision in a
sudden stop.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 211
DRIVING THROUGH WATER
Shallow Standing Water
Driving through water more than a few inches/ Although your vehicle is capable of driving through
centimeters deep will require extra caution to ensure shallow standing water, consider the following Caution
safety and prevent damage to your vehicle.
and Warning before doing so.
Flowing/Rising Water
CAUTION!
WARNING!
Do not drive on or across a road or path where water
is flowing and/or rising (as in storm run-off). Flowing water can wear away the road or path’s surface
and cause your vehicle to sink into deeper water.
Furthermore, flowing and/or rising water can carry
your vehicle away swiftly. Failure to follow this
warning may result in injuries that are serious or
fatal to you, your passengers, and others around you.
• Always check the depth of the standing water
before driving through it. Never drive through
standing water that is deeper than the bottom of
the tire rims mounted on the vehicle.
• Determine the condition of the road or the path
that is under water and if there are any obstacles in
the way before driving through the standing water.
• Do not exceed 5 mph (8 km/h) when driving
through standing water. This will minimize wave
effects.
(Continued)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
212 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION! (Continued)
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Driving through standing water may cause damage
to your vehicle’s drivetrain components. Always
inspect your vehicle’s fluids (i.e., transmission,
coolant, etc.) for signs of contamination (i.e., fluid
that is milky or foamy in appearance) after driving
through standing water. Do not continue to operate
the vehicle if any fluid appears contaminated, as
this may result in further damage. Such damage is
not covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
• Driving through standing water limits your vehicle’s traction capabilities. Do not exceed 5 mph
(8 km/h) when driving through standing water.
• Driving through standing water limits your vehicle’s braking capabilities, which increases stopping
distances. Therefore, after driving through standing water, drive slowly and lightly press on the
brake pedal several times to dry the brakes.
• Failure to follow these warnings may result in
injuries that are serious or fatal to you, your passengers, and others around you.
(Continued)
POWER STEERING
The electric power steering system will give you good
vehicle response and increased ease of maneuverability
in tight spaces. The system will vary its assist to provide
light efforts while parking and good feel while driving. If
the electric steering system experiences a fault that
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 213
prevents it from providing assist, you will still have the to “Electronic Vehicle Information (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel” for further information.
ability to steer the vehicle manually.
WARNING!
Continued operation with reduced or no power steering assist could pose a safety risk to yourself and
others. Service should be obtained as soon as possible.
If the Steering icon, and the ⬙SERVICE POWER STEERING - ASSIST OFF⬙ message is displayed on the EVIC
screen, the vehicle needs to be taken to an authorized
dealer for service. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Information (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your Instrument Panel”
for further information.
If the Steering icon is flashing, it indicates that the vehicle
NOTE:
needs to be taken to an authorized dealer for service. It is
likely the vehicle has lost power steering assistance.
• Even if the power steering assistance is no longer
operational, it is still possible to steer the vehicle.
If the Steering icon is displayed and the “SERVICE
Under these conditions there will be a substantial
POWER STEERING” message is displayed on the EVIC
increase in steering effort, especially at low speeds and
screen, they indicate that extreme steering maneuvers
during parking maneuvers.
may have occurred which caused an over temperature
condition in the power steering system. Once driving • If the condition persists, see your authorized dealer for
conditions are safe, pull over and let the vehicle idle for
service.
a few moments until the icon and message turn off. Refer
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
214 STARTING AND OPERATING
PARKING BRAKE
Before leaving the vehicle, make sure that the parking
brake is fully applied.
The parking brake lever is located in the center console.
To apply the parking brake, pull the lever up as firmly as
possible. To release the parking brake, pull the lever up
slightly, push the center button, then lower the lever
completely.
Parking Brake
When the parking brake is applied with the ignition
switch in the MAR (ACC/ON/RUN) position, the Brake
Warning Light in the instrument cluster will illuminate.
When parking on a hill, it is important to turn the front
wheels toward the curb on a downhill grade and away
from the curb on an uphill grade. The parking brake
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 215
should always be applied whenever the driver is not in
the vehicle.
WARNING!
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle.
• Allowing children to be in a vehicle unattended is
dangerous for a number of reasons. A child or others
could be seriously or fatally injured. Children
should be warned not to touch the parking brake,
brake pedal or the transmission push buttons.
• Do not leave the key fob in or near the vehicle (or
in a location accessible to children). A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
WARNING! (Continued)
• Be sure the parking brake is fully disengaged
before driving; failure to do so can lead to brake
failure and a collision.
• Always fully apply the parking brake when leaving your vehicle, or it may roll and cause damage or
injury.
CAUTION!
If the Brake Warning Light remains on with the
parking brake released, a brake system malfunction
is indicated. Have the brake system serviced by an
authorized dealer immediately.
(Continued)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
216 STARTING AND OPERATING
All systems work together to enhance vehicle stability
and control in various driving conditions and are comIn the event regenerative braking or power assist is lost
monly referred to as ESC.
for any reason the brakes will still function. The effort
required to brake the vehicle will be significantly more Four-Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
than that required with the power system operating.
The Four-Wheel ABS is designed to aid the driver in
If either the front or rear hydraulic system loses normal maintaining vehicle control under adverse braking concapability, the remaining system will still function with ditions. The system operates with a separate computer to
some loss of braking effectiveness. This will be evident by modulate hydraulic pressure, to prevent wheel lock-up
increased pedal travel during application, greater pedal and to help avoid skidding on slippery surfaces.
force required to slow or stop, and activation of the Brake The system’s pump motor runs during an ABS stop to
Warning Light and the ABS Warning Light during brake provide regulated hydraulic pressure. The pump motor
use.
makes a low humming noise during operation, which is
BRAKE SYSTEM
ELECTRONIC BRAKE CONTROL SYSTEM
normal.
Your vehicle is equipped with a advanced electronic The ABS includes an amber ABS Warning Light. When
brake control system that includes the Anti-Lock Brake the light is illuminated, the ABS is not functioning. The
System (ABS), Brake Assist System (BAS), Traction Con- system reverts to standard non-anti-lock brakes. Turning
trol System (TCS), and Electronic Stability Control (ESC).
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 217
the ignition Off and On again may reset the ABS if the
fault detected was only momentary.
WARNING!
• Pumping the Anti-Lock Brakes will diminish their
effectiveness and may lead to a collision. Pumping
makes the stopping distance longer. Just press
firmly on your brake pedal when you need to slow
down or stop.
• The Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) cannot prevent
the natural laws of physics from acting on the
vehicle, nor can it increase braking or steering
efficiency beyond that afforded by the condition of
the vehicle brakes and tires or the traction afforded.
• The ABS cannot prevent collisions, including those
resulting from excessive speed in turns, following
another vehicle too closely, or hydroplaning.
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• The capabilities of an ABS-equipped vehicle must
never be exploited in a reckless or dangerous
manner, which could jeopardize the user’s safety or
the safety of others.
When you are in a severe braking condition involving the
use of the ABS, you will experience some pedal drop as
the vehicle comes to a stop. This is the result of the
system reverting to the base brake system.
Engagement of the ABS may be accompanied by a
pulsing sensation. You may also hear a clicking noise.
These occurrences are normal and indicate that the
system is functioning properly.
Brake Assist System (BAS)
The BAS is designed to optimize the vehicle’s braking
capability during emergency braking maneuvers. The
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
218 STARTING AND OPERATING
system detects an emergency braking situation by sensWARNING! (Continued)
ing the rate and amount of brake application and then
•
The
BAS
cannot
prevent collisions, including those
applies optimum pressure to the brakes. This can help
resulting
from
excessive
speed in turns, driving on
reduce braking distances. The BAS complements the
very
slippery
surfaces,
or
hydroplaning.
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS). Applying the brakes very
•
The
capabilities
of
a
BAS-equipped
vehicle must
quickly results in the best BAS assistance. To receive the
never
be
exploited
in
a
reckless
or
dangerous
benefit of the system, you must apply continuous brakmanner
which
could
jeopardize
the
user’s
safety or
ing pressure during the stopping sequence (do not
the
safety
of
others.
“pump” the brakes). Do not reduce brake pedal pressure
unless braking is no longer desired. Once the brake pedal
Traction Control System (TCS)
is released, the BAS is deactivated.
This system monitors the amount of wheel spin of each of
the driven wheels. If wheel spin is detected, brake
WARNING!
pressure is applied to the slipping wheel(s) and vehicle
• The Brake Assist System (BAS) cannot prevent the power is reduced to provide enhanced acceleration and
natural laws of physics from acting on the vehicle, stability. A feature of the TCS system, Brake Limited
nor can it increase the traction afforded by prevail- Differential (BLD), functions similar to a limited slip
ing road conditions.
differential and controls the wheel spin across a driven
axle. If one wheel on a driven axle is spinning faster than
(Continued)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 219
the other, the system will apply the brake of the spinning
wheel. This will allow more torque to be applied to the
wheel that is not spinning. This feature remains active
even if TCS and ESC are in the Partial Off mode. Refer to
“Electronic Stability Control (ESC)” in this section for
further information.
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)
ESC applies the brake of the appropriate wheel to assist
in counteracting the oversteer or understeer condition.
• Oversteer - when the vehicle is turning more than
appropriate for the steering wheel position.
• Understeer - when the vehicle is turning less than
appropriate for the steering wheel position.
NOTE: The ESC Off switch is located on the instrument
This system enhances directional control and stability of
the vehicle under various driving conditions. ESC cor- panel.
rects for oversteering or understeering of the vehicle by
WARNING!
applying the brake of the appropriate wheel to assist in
counteracting the oversteering or understeering condi- • The Electronic Stability Control (ESC) cannot pretion. Vehicle power may also be reduced to help the
vent the natural laws of physics from acting on the
vehicle maintain the desired path. ESC uses sensors in
vehicle, nor can it increase the traction afforded by
the vehicle to determine the vehicle path intended by the
prevailing road conditions. ESC cannot prevent all
driver and compares it to the actual path of the vehicle.
accidents, including those resulting from excessive
When the actual path does not match the intended path,
speed in turns, driving on very slippery surfaces, or
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
(Continued)
5
220 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
hydroplaning. ESC also cannot prevent collisions
resulting from loss of vehicle control due to inappropriate driver input for the conditions. Only a
safe, attentive, and skillful driver can prevent accidents. The capabilities of an ESC equipped vehicle
must never be exploited in a reckless or dangerous
manner which could jeopardize the user’s safety or
the safety of others.
• Vehicle modifications, or failure to properly maintain your vehicle, may change the handling characteristics of your vehicle, and may negatively affect
the performance of the ESC system. Changes to the
steering system, suspension, braking system, tire
type and size or wheel size may adversely affect
(Continued)
ESC performance. Improperly inflated and unevenly worn tires may also degrade ESC performance. Any vehicle modification or poor vehicle
maintenance that reduces the effectiveness of the
ESC system can increase the risk of loss of vehicle
control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.
ESC Operating Modes
The ESC system has two available operating modes.
Full On
This is the normal operating mode for ESC. Whenever
the vehicle is started, the ESC system will be in On mode.
This mode should be used for most driving situations.
ESC should only be turned to Partial Off for specific
reasons as noted below.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 221
Partial Off
WARNING!
This mode is entered by momentarily pushing the ESC
Off switch. This mode is intended to be used if the vehicle
is in deep snow, sand or gravel conditions and more
wheel spin than ESC would normally allow is required to
gain traction.
To turn ESC on again, momentarily pushing the switch
again. This will restore the normal ESC On mode of
operation.
• When in “Partial Off” mode, the TCS functionality
of ESC, (except for the limited slip feature described in the TCS section), has been disabled and
the “ESC Off Indicator Light” will be illuminated.
When in “Partial Off” mode, the engine power
reduction feature of TCS is disabled, and the
enhanced vehicle stability offered by the ESC system is reduced.
NOTE: To improve the vehicle’s traction when driving ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light And
with snow chains, or starting off in deep snow, sand or ESC OFF Indicator Light
gravel, it may be desirable to switch to the Partial Off
mode by pushing the switch. Once the situation requiring
The ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator
ESC to be switched to the Partial Off mode is overcome,
Light in the instrument cluster will come on
turn ESC back on by momentarily pushing the switch.
when the ignition switch is turned to the MAR
This may be done while the vehicle is in motion.
(ACC/ON/RUN) position for four seconds. If
the ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light comes
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
222 STARTING AND OPERATING
on continuously with the vehicle operating running, a NOTE:
malfunction has been detected in the ESC system. If this
• The ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light and
light remains on after several ignition cycles, and the
the ESC OFF Indicator Light come on momentarily
vehicle has been driven several miles (kilometers) at
each time the ignition switch is turned ON.
speeds greater than 30 mph (48 km/h), see your authorized dealer as soon as possible to have the problem • Each time the ignition is turned ON, the ESC system
will be ON even if it was turned off previously.
diagnosed and corrected.
The ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light (located
The ESC OFF Indicator Light indicates the
in the instrument cluster) starts to flash as soon as the
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) is partially
tires lose traction and the ESC system becomes active.
The ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator Light also
off.
flashes when TCS is active. If the ESC Activation/
Malfunction Indicator Light begins to flash during accel- Regenerative Braking System (RBS)
eration, ease up on the accelerator and apply as little
throttle as possible. Be sure to adapt your speed and
Your 500e has a Regenerative Braking System
driving to the prevailing road conditions.
(RBS). The RBS reduces the high voltage battery consumption of the vehicle, particularly in
stop-and-go city traffic. The electric motors
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 223
which propel the vehicle forward can operate as genera- TIRE SAFETY INFORMATION
tors when braking. The RBS recharges the high voltage
Tire Markings
battery under certain braking conditions by recapturing
energy that would otherwise be lost while braking. The
electric power that is generated goes back into the high
voltage battery for later use, for example when acceleration is desired.
The RBS uses conventional hydraulic friction brakes,
regenerative braking, or a combination to slow the vehicle. If the system detects slippery conditions while
braking, ONLY friction is used to slow the vehicle. The
RBS can result in extended life of the hydraulic service
brakes; however, all inspection, scheduled maintenance,
and service intervals for the vehicle service brakes must 1 — U.S. DOT Safety Standards 4 — Maximum Load
Code (TIN)
be followed.
2 — Size Designation
3 — Service Description
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5 — Maximum Pressure
6 — Treadwear, Traction and
Temperature Grades
5
224 STARTING AND OPERATING
letters “LT” that are molded into the sidewall preceding the size designation. Example: LT235/85R16.
NOTE:
• P (Passenger) — Metric tire sizing is based on U.S.
design standards. P-Metric tires have the letter “P” • Temporary spare tires are designed for temporary
molded into the sidewall preceding the size designaemergency use only. Temporary high pressure comtion. Example: P215/65R15 95H.
pact spare tires have the letter “T” or “S” molded into
the sidewall preceding the size designation. Example:
• European — Metric tire sizing is based on European
T145/80D18 103M.
design standards. Tires designed to this standard have
the tire size molded into the sidewall beginning with • High flotation tire sizing is based on U.S. design
the section width. The letter ⬙P⬙ is absent from this tire
standards and it begins with the tire diameter molded
size designation. Example: 215/65R15 96H.
into the sidewall. Example: 31x10.5 R15 LT.
• LT (Light Truck) — Metric tire sizing is based on U.S.
design standards. The size designation for LT-Metric
tires is the same as for P-Metric tires except for the
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 225
Tire Sizing Chart
EXAMPLE:
Example Size Designation: P215/65R15XL 95H, 215/65R15 96H, LT235/85R16C, T145/80D18 103M, 31x10.5 R15 LT
P = Passenger car tire size based on U.S. design standards, or
ⴖ....blank....ⴖ = Passenger car tire based on European design standards, or
LT = Light truck tire based on U.S. design standards, or
T or S = Temporary spare tire or
31 = Overall diameter in inches (in)
215, 235, 145 = Section width in millimeters (mm)
65, 85, 80 = Aspect ratio in percent (%)
– Ratio of section height to section width of tire, or
10.5 = Section width in inches (in)
R = Construction code
– ⬙R⬙ means radial construction, or
– ⬙D⬙ means diagonal or bias construction
15, 16, 18 = Rim diameter in inches (in)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
226 STARTING AND OPERATING
EXAMPLE:
Service Description:
95 = Load Index
– A numerical code associated with the maximum load a tire can carry
H = Speed Symbol
– A symbol indicating the range of speeds at which a tire can carry a load corresponding to
its load index under certain operating conditions
– The maximum speed corresponding to the speed symbol should only be achieved under
specified operating conditions (i.e., tire pressure, vehicle loading, road conditions, and
posted speed limits)
Load Identification:
Absence of the following load identification symbols on the sidewall of the tire indicates a Standard Load (SL) tire:
• XL = Extra load (or reinforced) tire, or
• LL = Light load tire or
• C, D, E, F, G = Load range associated with the maximum load a tire can carry at a specified pressure
Maximum Load – Maximum load indicates the maximum load this tire is designed to carry
Maximum Pressure – Maximum pressure indicates the maximum permissible cold tire inflation pressure for this tire
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 227
Look for the TIN on the outboard side of black sidewall
The TIN may be found on one or both sides of the tire, tires as mounted on the vehicle. If the TIN is not found on
however, the date code may only be on one side. Tires the outboard side, then you will find it on the inboard
side of the tire.
with white sidewalls will have the full TIN, including the
date code, located on the white sidewall side of the tire.
Tire Identification Number (TIN)
EXAMPLE:
DOT MA L9 ABCD 0301
DOT = Department of Transportation
– This symbol certifies that the tire is in compliance with the U.S. Department of Transportation tire
safety standards and is approved for highway use
MA = Code representing the tire manufacturing location (two digits)
L9 = Code representing the tire size (two digits)
ABCD = Code used by the tire manufacturer (one to four digits)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
228 STARTING AND OPERATING
EXAMPLE:
DOT MA L9 ABCD 0301
03 = Number representing the week in which the tire was manufactured (two digits)
– 03 means the 3rd week
01 = Number representing the year in which the tire was manufactured (two digits)
– 01 means the year 2001
– Prior to July 2000, tire manufacturers were only required to have one number to represent the year
in which the tire was manufactured. Example: 031 could represent the 3rd week of 1981 or 1991
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 229
Tire Terminology And Definitions
Term
B-Pillar
Cold Tire Inflation Pressure
Maximum Inflation Pressure
Recommended Cold Tire Inflation
Pressure
Tire Placard
Definition
The vehicle B-Pillar is the structural member of the body located behind the front door.
Cold tire inflation pressure is defined as the tire pressure after the vehicle has not been driven for at least three hours, or driven less than 1
mile (1.6 km) after sitting for a minimum of three hours. Inflation pressure is measured in units of PSI (pounds per square inch) or kPa (kilopascals).
The maximum inflation pressure is the maximum permissible cold tire
inflation pressure for this tire. The maximum inflation pressure is
molded into the sidewall.
Vehicle manufacturer’s recommended cold tire inflation pressure as
shown on the tire placard.
A label permanently attached to the vehicle describing the vehicle’s
loading capacity, the original equipment tire sizes and the recommended cold tire inflation pressures.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
230 STARTING AND OPERATING
Tire Loading And Tire Pressure
Tire And Loading Information Placard Location
NOTE: The proper cold tire inflation pressure is listed on
the driver’s side B-Pillar or the rear edge of the driver’s
side door.
Example Tire Placard Location (B-Pillar)
Example Tire Placard Location (Door)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 231
4. Cold tire inflation pressures for the front, rear, and
spare tires.
Tire And Loading Information Placard
Loading
The vehicle maximum load on the tire must not exceed
the load carrying capacity of the tire on your vehicle. You
will not exceed the tire’s load carrying capacity if you
adhere to the loading conditions, tire size, and cold tire
inflation pressures specified on the Tire and Loading
Information placard in “Vehicle Loading” in the “Starting
And Operating” section of this manual.
Tire And Loading Information Placard
This placard tells you important information about the:
1. Number of people that can be carried in the vehicle.
2. Total weight your vehicle can carry.
3. Tire size designed for your vehicle.
NOTE: Under a maximum loaded vehicle condition,
gross axle weight ratings (GAWRs) for the front and rear
axles must not be exceeded. For further information on
GAWRs, vehicle loading, and trailer towing, refer to
“Vehicle Loading” in the “Starting And Operating” section of this manual.
To determine the maximum loading conditions of your
vehicle, locate the statement “The combined weight of
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
232 STARTING AND OPERATING
is 650 lbs (294 kg) (since 5 x 150 lbs (68 kg) = 750 lbs
occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX lbs or
XXX kg” on the Tire and Loading Information placard.
(340 kg), and 1400 lbs (635 kg) – 750 lbs (340 kg) =
The combined weight of occupants, cargo/luggage and
650 lbs [294 kg]).
trailer tongue weight (if applicable) should never exceed 5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo
the weight referenced here.
being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not
safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load
Steps For Determining Correct Load Limit
capacity calculated in step 4.
1. Locate the statement “The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX lbs or NOTE:
XXX kg” on your vehicle’s placard.
• If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your
trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. The follow2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and
ing table shows examples on how to calculate total
passengers that will be riding in your vehicle.
load, cargo/luggage, and towing capacities of your
3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and pasvehicle with varying seating configurations and numsengers from XXX lbs or XXX kg.
ber and size of occupants. This table is for illustration
4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of
purposes only and may not be accurate for the seating
cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if
and load carry capacity of your vehicle.
“XXX” amount equals 1,400 lbs (635 kg) and there will
• For the following example, the combined weight of
be five 150 lb (68 kg) passengers in your vehicle, the
occupants and cargo should never exceed 865 lbs (392 kg).
amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 233
5
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
234 STARTING AND OPERATING
Safety
WARNING!
Overloading of your tires is dangerous. Overloading
can cause tire failure, affect vehicle handling, and
increase your stopping distance. Use tires of the
recommended load capacity for your vehicle. Never
overload them.
TIRES — GENERAL INFORMATION
Tire Pressure
Proper tire inflation pressure is essential to the safe and
satisfactory operation of your vehicle. Four primary areas
are affected by improper tire pressure:
• Safety and Vehicle Stability
WARNING!
• Improperly inflated tires are dangerous and can
cause collisions.
• Underinflation increases tire flexing and can result
in overheating and tire failure.
• Overinflation reduces a tire’s ability to cushion
shock. Objects on the road and chuckholes can
cause damage that result in tire failure.
• Overinflated or underinflated tires can affect vehicle handling and can fail suddenly, resulting in
loss of vehicle control.
• Unequal tire pressures can cause steering problems. You could lose control of your vehicle.
• Energy Consumption
(Continued)
• Tread Wear
• Ride Comfort
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 235
Energy Consumption
WARNING! (Continued)
• Unequal tire pressures from one side of the vehicle
to the other can cause the vehicle to drift to the
right or left.
• Always drive with each tire inflated to the recommended cold tire inflation pressure.
Underinflated tires will increase tire rolling resistance
resulting in higher battery charge consumption.
Tread Wear
Improper cold tire inflation pressures can cause abnormal wear patterns and reduced tread life, resulting in the
Both under-inflation and over-inflation affect the stability need for earlier tire replacement.
of the vehicle and can produce a feeling of sluggish Ride Comfort And Vehicle Stability
response or over responsiveness in the steering.
Proper tire inflation contributes to a comfortable ride.
NOTE:
Over-inflation produces a jarring and uncomfortable
• Unequal tire pressures from side to side may cause ride.
erratic and unpredictable steering response.
Tire Inflation Pressures
• Unequal tire pressure from side to side may cause the The proper cold tire inflation pressure is listed on the
vehicle to drift left or right.
driver’s side B-Pillar or rear edge of the driver’s side
door.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
236 STARTING AND OPERATING
At least once a month:
mile (1.6 km) after sitting for a minimum of three hours.
The cold tire inflation pressure must not exceed the
• Check and adjust tire pressure with a good quality
maximum inflation pressure molded into the tire sidepocket-type pressure gauge. Do not make a visual
wall.
judgement when determining proper inflation. Tires
may look properly inflated even when they are under- Check tire pressures more often if subject to a wide range
of outdoor temperatures, as tire pressures vary with
inflated.
temperature changes.
• Inspect tires for signs of tire wear or visible damage.
Tire pressures change by approximately 1 psi (7 kPa) per
12°F (7°C) of air temperature change. Keep this in mind
CAUTION!
when checking tire pressure inside a garage, especially in
After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure, althe Winter.
ways reinstall the valve stem cap. This will prevent
Example: If garage temperature = 68°F (20°C) and the
moisture and dirt from entering the valve stem,
outside temperature = 32°F (0°C) then the cold tire
which could damage the valve stem.
inflation pressure should be increased by 3 psi (21 kPa),
Inflation pressures specified on the placard are always which equals 1 psi (7 kPa) for every 12°F (7°C) for this
“cold tire inflation pressure”. Cold tire inflation pressure outside temperature condition.
is defined as the tire pressure after the vehicle has not
been driven for at least three hours, or driven less than 1
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 237
Tire pressure may increase from 2 to 6 psi (13 to 40 kPa)
during operation. DO NOT reduce this normal pressure
build up or your tire pressure will be too low.
Tire Pressures For High Speed Operation
WARNING!
High speed driving with your vehicle under maximum load is dangerous. The added strain on your
tires could cause them to fail. You could have a
serious collision. Do not drive a vehicle loaded to the
maximum capacity at continuous speeds above
75 mph (120 km/h).
The manufacturer advocates driving at safe speeds and
within posted speed limits. Where speed limits or conditions are such that the vehicle can be driven at high
speeds, maintaining correct tire inflation pressure is very
important. Increased tire pressure and reduced vehicle Radial Ply Tires
loading may be required for high-speed vehicle operation. Refer to your authorized tire dealer or original
WARNING!
equipment vehicle dealer for recommended safe operatCombining radial ply tires with other types of tires
ing speeds, loading and cold tire inflation pressures.
on your vehicle will cause your vehicle to handle
poorly. The instability could cause a collision. Always use radial ply tires in sets of four. Never
combine them with other types of tires.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
238 STARTING AND OPERATING
Tire Repair
Tire Types
If your tire becomes damaged, it may be repaired if it All Season Tires — If Equipped
meets the following criteria:
All Season tires provide traction for all seasons (Spring,
Summer, Fall and Winter). Traction levels may vary
• The tire has not been driven on when flat.
between different all season tires. All season tires can be
• The damage is only on the tread section of your tire
identified by the M+S, M&S, M/S or MS designation on
(sidewall damage is not repairable).
the tire sidewall. Use all season tires only in sets of four;
• The puncture is no greater than a ¼ of an inch (6 mm). failure to do so may adversely affect the safety and
handling of your vehicle.
Consult an authorized tire dealer for tire repairs and
additional information.
Summer Or Three Season Tires — If Equipped
Damaged Run Flat tires, or Run Flat tires that have
experienced a loss of pressure should be replaced immediately with another Run Flat tire of identical size and
service description (Load Index and Speed Symbol).
Summer tires provide traction in both wet and dry
conditions, and are not intended to be driven in snow or
on ice. If your vehicle is equipped with Summer tires, be
aware these tires are not designed for Winter or cold
driving conditions. Install Winter tires on your vehicle
when ambient temperatures are less than 40°F (5°C) or if
roads are covered with ice or snow. For more information, contact an authorized dealer.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 239
Summer tires do not contain the all season designation or
mountain/snowflake symbol on the tire sidewall. Use
Summer tires only in sets of four; failure to do so may
adversely affect the safety and handling of your vehicle.
Snow Tires
Some areas of the country require the use of snow tires
during the Winter. Snow tires can be identified by a
“mountain/snowflake” symbol on the tire sidewall.
If you need snow tires, select tires
equivalent in size and type to the original equipment tires. Use snow tires
only in sets of four; failure to do so
may adversely affect the safety and
handling of your vehicle.
WARNING!
Do not use Summer tires in snow/ice conditions. You
could lose vehicle control, resulting in severe injury
or death. Driving too fast for conditions also creates
the possibility of loss of vehicle control.
Snow tires generally have lower speed ratings than what
was originally equipped with your vehicle and should
not be operated at sustained speeds over 75 mph
(120 km/h). For speeds above 75 mph (120 km/h) refer to
original equipment or an authorized tire dealer for
recommended safe operating speeds, loading and cold
tire inflation pressures.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
240 STARTING AND OPERATING
While studded tires improve performance on ice, skid
and traction capability on wet or dry surfaces may be
poorer than that of non-studded tires. Some states prohibit studded tires; therefore, local laws should be
checked before using these tire types.
Run Flat Tires — If Equipped
Run Flat tires allow you the capability to drive 50 miles
(80 km) at 50 mph (80 km/h) after a rapid loss of inflation
pressure. This rapid loss of inflation is referred to as the
Run Flat mode. A Run Flat mode occurs when the tire
inflation pressure is of/or below 14 psi (96 kPa). Once a
Run Flat tire reaches the run flat mode it has limited
driving capabilities and needs to be replaced immediately. A Run Flat tire is not repairable.
See the tire pressure monitoring section for more information.
Spare Tires — If Equipped
NOTE: For vehicles equipped with Tire Service Kit
instead of a spare tire, please refer to “Tire Service Kit” in
“What To Do In Emergencies” for further information.
CAUTION!
Because of the reduced ground clearance, do not take
your vehicle through an automatic car wash with a
compact or limited-use temporary spare installed.
Damage to the vehicle may result.
Spare Tire Matching Original Equipped Tire And
It is not recommended driving a vehicle loaded at full Wheel — If Equipped
capacity or to tow a trailer while a tire is in the run flat
Your vehicle may be equipped with a spare tire and
mode.
wheel equivalent in look and function to the original
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 241
equipment tire and wheel found on the front or rear axle
of your vehicle. This spare tire may be used in the tire
rotation for your vehicle. If your vehicle has this option,
refer to an authorized tire dealer for the recommended
tire rotation pattern.
Since this tire has limited tread life, the original equipment tire should be repaired (or replaced) and reinstalled
on your vehicle at the first opportunity.
Do not install a wheel cover or attempt to mount a
conventional tire on the compact spare wheel, since the
wheel is designed specifically for the compact spare tire.
Compact Spare Tire — If Equipped
The compact spare is for temporary emergency use only. Do not install more than one compact spare tire and
You can identify if your vehicle is equipped with a wheel on the vehicle at any given time.
compact spare by looking at the spare tire description on
WARNING!
the Tire and Loading Information Placard located on the
driver’s side door opening or on the sidewall of the tire. Compact spares are for temporary emergency use
Compact spare tire descriptions begin with the letter “T” only. With these spares, do not drive more than
or “S” preceding the size designation. Example: T145/ 50 mph (80 km/h). Temporary use spares have limited
80D18 103M.
tread life. When the tread is worn to the tread wear
indicators, the temporary use spare tire needs to be
T, S = Temporary Spare Tire
replaced. Be sure to follow the warnings, which
apply to your spare. Failure to do so could result in
spare tire failure and loss of vehicle control.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
242 STARTING AND OPERATING
your original equipment tire, replace (or repair) the
original equipment tire and reinstall on the vehicle at the
The full size spare is for temporary emergency use only.
first opportunity.
This tire may look like the originally equipped tire on the
front or rear axle of your vehicle, but it is not. This spare
WARNING!
tire may have limited tread life. When the tread is worn
to the tread wear indicators, the temporary use full size Limited-use spares are for emergency use only. Inspare tire needs to be replaced. Since it is not the same as
stallation of this limited-use spare tire affects vehicle
your original equipment tire, replace (or repair) the handling. With this tire, do not drive more than the
original equipment tire and reinstall on the vehicle at the speed listed on the limit-use spare wheel. Keep
first opportunity.
inflated to the cold tire inflation pressures listed on
Full Size Spare — If Equipped
Limited-Use Spare — If Equipped
The limited-use spare tire is for temporary emergency
use only. This tire is identified by a label located on the
limited-use spare wheel. This label contains the driving
limitations for this spare. This tire may look like the
original equipped tire on the front or rear axle of your
vehicle, but it is not. Installation of this limited-use spare
tire affects vehicle handling. Since it is not the same as
your Tire and Loading Information Placard located
on the driver’s side B-Pillar or the rear edge of the
driver’s side door. Replace (or repair) the original
equipment tire at the first opportunity and reinstall it
on your vehicle. Failure to do so could result in loss
of vehicle control.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 243
Tire Spinning
Tread Wear Indicators
When stuck in mud, sand, snow, or ice conditions, do not Tread wear indicators are in the original equipment tires
spin your vehicle’s wheels above 30 mph (48 km/h) or to help you in determining when your tires should be
for longer than 30 seconds continuously without stop- replaced.
ping.
Refer to “Freeing A Stuck Vehicle” in “What To Do In
Emergencies” for further information.
WARNING!
Fast spinning tires can be dangerous. Forces generated by excessive wheel speeds may cause tire damage or failure. A tire could explode and injure someone. Do not spin your vehicle’s wheels faster than
30 mph (48 km/h) for more than 30 seconds continuously when you are stuck, and do not let anyone near
a spinning wheel, no matter what the speed.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
244 STARTING AND OPERATING
worn to the tread wear indicators, the tire should be
replaced. Refer to “Replacement Tires” in this section for
further information.
Life Of Tire
The service life of a tire is dependent upon varying
factors including, but not limited to:
• Driving style.
Tire Tread
1 — Worn Tire
2 — New Tire
• Tire pressure - Improper cold tire inflation pressures can
cause uneven wear patterns to develop across the tire
tread. These abnormal wear patterns will reduce tread
life, resulting in the need for earlier tire replacement.
• Distance driven.
• Performance tires, tires with a speed rating of V or
higher, and Summer tires typically have a reduced
These indicators are molded into the bottom of the tread
tread life. Rotation of these tires per the vehicle maingrooves. They will appear as bands when the tread depth
tenance schedule is highly recommended.
becomes a 1/16 of an inch (1.6 mm). When the tread is
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 245
WARNING!
Tires and the spare tire should be replaced after six
years, regardless of the remaining tread. Failure to
follow this warning can result in sudden tire failure.
You could lose control and have a collision resulting
in serious injury or death.
Information placard or the Vehicle Certification Label for
the size designation of your tire. The Load Index and
Speed Symbol for your tire will be found on the original
equipment tire sidewall. See the Tire Sizing Chart example found in the “Tire Safety Information” section of
this manual for more information relating to the Load
Index and Speed Symbol of a tire.
Keep dismounted tires in a cool, dry place with as little It is recommended to replace the two front tires or two
exposure to light as possible. Protect tires from contact rear tires as a pair. Replacing just one tire can seriously
affect your vehicle’s handling. If you ever replace a
with oil, grease, and gasoline.
wheel, make sure that the wheel’s specifications match
Replacement Tires
those of the original wheels.
The tires on your new vehicle provide a balance of many
characteristics. They should be inspected regularly for
wear and correct cold tire inflation pressures. The manufacturer strongly recommends that you use tires equivalent to the originals in size, quality and performance
when replacement is needed. Refer to the paragraph on
“Tread Wear Indicator”. Refer to the Tire and Loading
It is recommended you contact your authorized tire
dealer or original equipment dealer with any questions
you may have on tire specifications or capability. Failure
to use equivalent replacement tires may adversely affect
the safety, handling, and ride of your vehicle.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
246 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not use a tire, wheel size or rating other than
that specified for your vehicle. Some combinations
of unapproved tires and wheels may change suspension dimensions and performance characteristics, resulting in changes to steering, handling, and
braking of your vehicle. This can cause unpredictable handling and stress to steering and suspension components. You could lose control and have
a collision resulting in serious injury or death. Use
only the tire and wheel sizes with load ratings
approved for your vehicle.
• Never use a tire with a smaller load index or
capacity, other than what was originally equipped
on your vehicle. Using a tire with a smaller load
index could result in tire overloading and failure.
You could lose control and have a collision.
• Failure to equip your vehicle with tires having
adequate speed capability can result in sudden tire
failure and loss of vehicle control.
CAUTION!
Replacing original tires with tires of a different size
may result in false speedometer and odometer
readings.
(Continued)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 247
TIRE CHAINS (TRACTION DEVICES)
CAUTION!
Use of traction devices require sufficient tire-to-body
clearance. Follow these recommendations to guard
against damage.
• Traction device must be of proper size for the tire, as
recommended by the traction device manufacturer
• Install on Front Tires
• Due to limited clearance, a 185/55R15 tire with a
Security Chain Company (SCC) Super Z6 low profile
traction device or equivalent is recommended
WARNING!
Using tires of different size and type (M+S, Snow)
between front and rear axles can cause unpredictable
handling. You could lose control and have a collision.
To avoid damage to your vehicle or tires, observe the
following precautions:
• Because of restricted chain clearance between tires
and other suspension components, it is important
that only chains in good condition are used. Broken
chains can cause serious damage. Stop the vehicle
immediately if noise occurs that could indicate
chain breakage. Remove the damaged parts of the
chain before further use.
• Install chains on the front wheels as tightly as
possible and then retighten after driving about ½
mile (0.8 km).
• Do not exceed 30 mph (48 km/h).
• Drive cautiously and avoid severe turns and large
bumps, especially with a loaded vehicle.
(Continued)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
248 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Do not drive for prolonged period on dry pavement.
• Observe the tire chain manufacturer’s instructions
on the method of installation, operating speed, and
conditions for use. Always use the lower suggested
operating speed of the chain manufacturer if different from the speed recommended by the manufacture.
• Do not use traction devices on a compact spare tire.
These effects can be reduced by timely rotation of tires.
The benefits of rotation are especially worthwhile with
aggressive tread designs such as those on all season type
tires. Rotation will increase tread life, help to maintain
mud, snow and wet traction levels, and contribute to a
smooth, quiet ride.
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
maintenance intervals. The reasons for any rapid or
unusual wear should be corrected prior to rotation being
performed.
The front and rear wheels are different sizes and cannot
be used in place of each other. Rotate the wheels “sideThe tires on the front and rear of your vehicle operate at to-side” as shown in the diagram.
different loads and perform different steering, driving,
and braking functions. For these reasons, they wear at
unequal rates.
TIRE ROTATION RECOMMENDATIONS
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 249
Tire Rotation
PREMIUM TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR SYSTEM
The tire pressure will vary with temperature by about 1psi
(7 kPa) for every 12°F (6.5°C). This means that when the
outside temperature decreases, the tire pressure will decrease. Tire pressure should always be set based on cold
inflation tire pressure. This is defined as the tire pressure
after the vehicle has not been driven for at least three
hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km) after a three hour
period. The cold tire inflation pressure must not exceed the
maximum inflation pressure molded into the tire sidewall.
Refer to “Tires – General Information” in “Starting And
Operating” for information on how to properly inflate the
vehicle’s tires. The tire pressure will also increase as the
vehicle is driven. This is normal and there should be no
adjustment for this increased pressure.
The Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) will warn the The TPMS will warn the driver of a low tire pressure if
driver of a low tire pressure based on the vehicle recom- the tire pressure falls below the low-pressure warning
mended cold placard pressure.
limit for any reason, including low temperature effects
and natural pressure loss through the tire.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
250 STARTING AND OPERATING
The TPMS will continue to warn the driver of low tire
pressure as long as the condition exists, and will not turn
off until the tire pressure is at or above the recommended
cold placard pressure. Once the low tire pressure warning (Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light) illuminates,
you must increase the tire pressure to the recommended
cold placard pressure in order for the “Tire Pressure
Monitoring Telltale Light” to turn off. The system will
automatically update and the “Tire Pressure Monitoring
Telltale Light” will turn off once the system receives the
updated tire pressures. The vehicle may need to be
driven for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph (24 km/h) in
order for the TPMS to receive this information.
For example, your vehicle may have a recommended
cold (parked for more than three hours) placard pressure
of 33 psi (227 kPa). If the ambient temperature is 68°F
(20°C) and the measured tire pressure is 28 psi (193 kPa),
a temperature drop to 20°F (-7°C) will decrease the tire
pressure to approximately 24 psi (165 kPa). This tire
pressure is low enough to turn ON the “Tire Pressure
Monitoring Telltale Light.” Driving the vehicle may cause
the tire pressure to rise to approximately 28 psi (193 kPa),
but the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will still
be on. In this situation, the “Tire Pressure Monitoring
Telltale Light” will turn off only after the tires are inflated
to the vehicle’s recommended cold placard pressure
value.
CAUTION!
• The TPMS has been optimized for the original
equipment tires and wheels. TPMS pressures and
warnings have been established for the tire size
equipped on your vehicle. Undesirable system operation or sensor damage may result when using
replacement equipment that is not of the same size,
type, and/or style. Aftermarket wheels can cause
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 251
CAUTION! (Continued)
sensor damage. Using aftermarket tire sealants may
cause the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
sensor to become inoperable. After using an aftermarket tire sealant it is recommended that you take
your vehicle to an authorized dealership to have
your sensor function checked.
• After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure,
always reinstall the valve stem cap. This will
prevent moisture and dirt from entering the valve
stem, which could damage the Tire Pressure Monitoring Sensor.
• The TPMS should not be used as a tire pressure gauge
while adjusting your tire pressure.
• Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes
the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure.
• Under-inflation also reduces the high voltage battery
range and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s
handling and stopping ability.
• It is particularly important for you to check the tire
pressure in all of the tires on your vehicle monthly and
to maintain the proper pressure.
• The TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain
NOTE:
correct tire pressure using an accurate tire pressure
gauge, even if under-inflation has not reached the level
• The TPMS is not intended to replace normal tire care
to trigger illumination of the “Tire Pressure Monitorand maintenance, or to provide warning of a tire
ing Telltale Light”.
failure or condition.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
252 STARTING AND OPERATING
• Seasonal temperature changes will affect tire pressure, Tire Pressure Monitoring Low Pressure Warnings
and the TPMS will monitor the actual tire pressure in
The “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will
the tire.
illuminate in the instrument cluster and a chime will
sound when tire pressure is low in one or more of the
Premium TPM System
four active road tires. In addition, the Electronic
The Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) uses wireless
Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) will display a
technology with wheel rim mounted electronic sensors to
graphic showing the pressure values of each tire with
monitor tire pressure levels. Sensors, mounted to each
the low tire pressure tire highlighted in a different
wheel as part of the valve stem, transmit tire pressure
color.
readings to the receiver module.
The TPMS consists of the following components:
• Receiver module
• Four Tire Pressure Monitoring Sensors
• Various Tire Pressure Monitoring System messages,
which display in the Electronic Vehicle Information
Center (EVIC)
• Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 253
receives the updated tire pressures, the system will automatically update and the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will turn off. The vehicle may need to be driven
for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph (24 km/h) in order for
the TPMS to receive this information.
TPMS Warning
When a system fault is detected, the “Tire Pressure
Monitoring Telltale Light” will flash on and off for 75
seconds and then remain on solid. The system fault will
sound a chime and also display a “Service Tire Pressure
Monitoring System” message in the EVIC for approximately 5 seconds.
Low Tire Indicator
Should this occur, you should stop as soon as possible and
inflate the tires with low pressure to the vehicle’s recommended cold placard pressure value. Once the system
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
254 STARTING AND OPERATING
A system fault can occur due to any of the following:
1. Signal interference due to electronic devices or driving
next to facilities emitting the same radio frequencies as
the TPM sensors.
2. Installing aftermarket window tinting that contains
materials that may block radio wave signals.
3. Accumulation of snow or ice around the wheels or
wheel housings.
4. Using tire chains on the vehicle.
5. Using wheels/tires not equipped with TPM sensors.
Service TPM System Message
NOTE:
If the ignition switch is cycled, this sequence will repeat,
providing the system fault still exists. If the system fault • The TPMS will not monitor the pressure in a replacement tire installed without a tire pressure sensor.
no longer exists, the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale
Light” will no longer flash, and the “Service TPM Sys- • If you install a replacement tire in place of a road tire
that has a pressure below the low-pressure warning
tem” message will no longer display.
limit, upon the next ignition switch cycle, the “Tire
Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will remain on and
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 255
a chime will sound. In addition, the highlighted warning limit in any of the four active road tires. The
graphic in the EVIC will still display a low pressure vehicle may need to be driven for up to 20 minutes above
text message and a pressure value in a different color. 15 mph (24 km/h) in order for the TPMS to receive this
information.
• After driving the vehicle for up to 20 minutes above
15 mph (24 km/h), the “Tire Pressure Monitoring General Information
Telltale Light” will flash on and off for 75 seconds and
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules and
then remain on solid. In addition, the EVIC will
RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the
display a “Service Tire Pressure Monitoring System”
following two conditions:
message.
(1) This device may not cause harmful interference.
• For each subsequent ignition switch cycle, a chime will
sound, the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” (2) This device must accept any interference received,
will flash on and off for 75 seconds and then remain on including interference that may cause undesired operation.
solid, and the EVIC will display a “Service TPM NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressly approved
System” message.
by the party responsible for compliance could void the
Once you repair or replace the original road tire and user’s authority to operate the equipment.
reinstall it, the TPMS will update automatically. In addition, the “Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light” will turn TRAILER TOWING
off, as long as no tire pressure is below the low-pressure Trailer towing with this vehicle is not recommended.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
256 STARTING AND OPERATING
RECREATIONAL TOWING (BEHIND MOTORHOME, ETC.)
Towing This Vehicle Behind Another Vehicle
Towing Condition
Flat Tow
Dolly Tow
On Trailer
Wheels OFF the Ground
NONE
Front
Rear
ALL
NOTE:
• When recreationally towing your vehicle, always follow applicable state and provincial laws. Contact state
and provincial Highway Safety offices for additional
details.
• This vehicle must be towed on a dolly or vehicle trailer
with the front wheels OFF the ground.
Single-Speed Transmission
NOT ALLOWED
OK
NOT ALLOWED
OK
CAUTION!
Towing this vehicle in violation of the above requirements can cause severe transmission damage. Damage from improper towing is not covered under the
New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
STARTING AND OPERATING 257
EXTENDING YOUR DRIVING RANGE PER
CHARGE
temperature before the drive and allow the battery to
maintain the temperature at significantly lower energy
levels.
The drive system and cabin temperature management
features use the most energy from the high voltage Additional tips:
battery. Reducing energy draw from these features are
• Keep tires properly inflated
the easiest and most effective way to extend driving
range.
• When practical, choose surface streets over the highway, and work to maintain a steady speed
The 500e uses high voltage components to heat and cool
the cabin, so when using automatic climate control, • Avoid carrying nonessential cargo
consider setting temperatures a few degrees higher or
• Be mindful of adding external accessories that may
lower during hot and cold days. If your 500e has been
increase aerodynamic drag
soaking in hot or cold temperatures for an extended
period, it is recommended that the car be preconditioned • Perform all scheduled maintenance at recommended
using the Uconnect Access smartphone app while still
intervals
plugged into a charging source. This will allow 500e to
Driver Behavior Gauge
use external power to establish a comfortable cabin
To help the driver extend the driving range of the high
voltage battery your vehicle is equipped with a Driver
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
258 STARTING AND OPERATING
Behavior Gauge. The Driver Behavior Gauge is located
on the right side of the instrument cluster and contains
three driving ranges:
• Power
The needle will move into the Power range when under
acceleration.
• ECO
The needle will move into the ECO range when you are
maximizing the driving range of the high voltage battery.
• Charge
The needle will move into the Charge range when battery
regeneration is active (either coasting or braking).
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Driver Behavior Gauge
STARTING AND OPERATING 259
• When both arrows are grey, expect the range to drop
approximately one mile for each mile driven.
This area of the cluster is used to display the projected
range considering current battery charge and previous • When the up arrow is highlighted, expect the range
energy use. The two arrows to the left of the mileage are
number to hold steady or increase while driving.
used to forecast the effect of recent driving.
• When the down arrow is highlighted, expect the range
number to decrease more than one mile for each mile
driven.
Range Projection
Range Projection Indicators
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
5
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
CONTENTS
䡵 HAZARD WARNING FLASHERS . . . . . . . . . . .262 䡵 JUMP-STARTING PROCEDURE (12 VOLT
BATTERY ONLY) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .274
䡵 WHEEL AND TIRE TORQUE
SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
▫ Preparations For Jump-Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
▫ Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
▫ Jump-Starting Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .276
䡵 TIRE SERVICE KIT — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . .264 䡵 FREEING A STUCK VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . .278
▫ Tire Service Kit Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .264 䡵 MANUAL PARK RELEASE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .279
▫ Tire Service Kit Components And Operation . .265 䡵 TOWING A DISABLED VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . .281
▫ Tire Service Kit Usage Precautions . . . . . . . . .266
▫ Sealing A Tire With Tire Service Kit . . . . . . . .268
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
6
262 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
HAZARD WARNING FLASHERS
WHEEL AND TIRE TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
The Hazard Warning flasher switch is located on the Proper lug nut/bolt torque is very important to ensure
that the wheel is properly mounted to the vehicle. Any
instrument panel below the radio.
time a wheel has been removed and reinstalled on the
Push the switch to turn on the Hazard Warning
vehicle the lug nuts/bolts should be torqued using a
flashers. When the switch is activated, all direc- properly calibrated torque wrench.
tional turn signals will flash on and off to warn oncoming
traffic of an emergency. Push the switch a second time to Torque Specifications
turn off the Hazard Warning flashers.
Lug Nut/Bolt Torque
**Lug Nut/
Lug Nut/
Do not use this emergency warning system when the
Bolt Size
Bolt Socket
vehicle is in motion. Use it when your vehicle is disabled
Size
and it is creating a safety hazard for other motorists.
17 mm
66 Ft-Lbs (90 N·m) Steel M12 x 1.25
Wheels Only
If it is necessary to leave the vehicle to go for service, the
74 Ft-Lbs (100 N·m)
Hazard Warning flashers will continue to operate with
Aluminum Wheels Only
the ignition key removed and the vehicle locked.
NOTE: With extended use, the Hazard Warning flashers **Use only your Authorized Dealer recommended lug
nuts/bolts and clean or remove any dirt or oil before
may wear down your battery.
tightening.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 263
Inspect the wheel mounting surface prior to mounting
the tire and remove any corrosion or loose particles.
6
Torque Patterns
After 25 miles (40 km) check the lug nut/bolt torque to be
sure that all the lug nuts/bolts are properly seated
Wheel Mounting Surface
Tighten the lug nuts/bolts in a star pattern until each against the wheel.
nut/bolt has been tightened twice.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
264 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
Tire Service Kit Storage
WARNING!
To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack,
do not tighten the lug nuts fully until the vehicle has
been lowered. Failure to follow this warning may
result in personal injury.
The Tire Service Kit is located in the rear cargo area.
TIRE SERVICE KIT — IF EQUIPPED
Small punctures up to 1/4 inch (6 mm) in the tire tread
can be sealed with Tire Service Kit. Foreign objects (e.g.,
screws or nails) should not be removed from the tire. Tire
Service Kit can be used in outside temperatures down to
approximately -4°F (-20°C).
This kit will provide a temporary tire seal, allowing you
to drive your vehicle up to 100 miles (160 km) with a
maximum speed of 55 mph (90 km/h).
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Tire Service Kit Location
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 265
Using The Mode Select Knob And Hoses
Tire Service Kit Components And Operation
Your Tire Service Kit is equipped with the following
symbols to indicate the air or sealant mode.
Selecting Air Mode
Push in the Mode Select Knob (5) and turn to this
position for air pump operation only. Use the
Black Air Pump Hose (7) when selecting this mode.
Selecting Sealant Mode
Push in the Mode Select Knob (5) and turn to this
position to inject the Tire Service Kit Sealant and
to inflate the tire. Use the Sealant Hose (clear hose) (6)
when selecting this mode.
Tire Service Kit Components
1
2
3
4
—
—
—
—
Sealant Bottle
Deflation Button
Pressure Gauge
Power Button
5 — Mode Select Knob
6 — Sealant Hose (Clear)
7 — Air Pump Hose (Black)
8 — Power Plug (located on the bottom side of the Tire Service Kit)
Using The Power Button
Push and release the Power Button (4) once to
turn On the Tire Service Kit. Push and release the Power
Button (4) again to turn Off the Tire Service Kit.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
6
266 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
Using The Deflation Button
Push the Deflation Button (2) to reduce the air
pressure in the tire if it becomes over-inflated.
Tire Service Kit Usage Precautions
• Replace the Tire Service Kit Sealant Bottle (1) and
Sealant Hose (6) prior to the expiration date (printed at
the lower right hand corner on the bottle label) to
assure optimum operation of the system. Refer to
“Sealing a Tire with Tire Service Kit” section (F)
“Sealant Bottle and Hose Replacement”.
Tire Service Kit Expiration Date Location
• The Sealant Bottle (1) and Sealant Hose (6) are a one
tire application use and need to be replaced after each
use. Always replace these components immediately at
your original equipment vehicle dealer.
• When the Tire Service Kit sealant is in a liquid form,
clean water, and a damp cloth will remove the material
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 267
from the vehicle or tire and wheel components. Once
the sealant dries, it can easily be peeled off and
properly discarded.
• For optimum performance, make sure the valve stem
on the wheel is free of debris before connecting the Tire
Service Kit.
• You can use the Tire Service Kit air pump to inflate
bicycle tires. The kit also comes with two needles,
located in the Accessory Storage Compartment (on the
bottom of the air pump) for inflating sport balls, rafts,
or similar inflatable items. However, use only the Air
Pump Hose (7) and make sure the Mode Select Knob
(5) is in the Air Mode when inflating such items to
avoid injecting sealant into them. The Tire Service Kit
Sealant is only intended to seal punctures less than 1/4
inch (6 mm) diameter in the tread of your vehicle.
• Do not lift or carry the Tire Service Kit by the hoses.
WARNING!
• Do not attempt to seal a tire on the side of the
vehicle closest to traffic. Pull far enough off the
road to avoid the danger of being hit when using
the Tire Service Kit.
• Do not use Tire Service Kit or drive the vehicle
under the following circumstances:
– If the puncture in the tire tread is approximately
1/4 inch (6 mm) or larger.
– If the tire has any sidewall damage.
– If the tire has any damage from driving with
extremely low tire pressure.
– If the tire has any damage from driving on a flat
tire.
– If the wheel has any damage.
– If you are unsure of the condition of the tire or
the wheel.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
(Continued)
6
268 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Keep Tire Service Kit away from open flames or
heat source.
• A loose Tire Service Kit thrown forward in a
collision or hard stop could endanger the occupants
of the vehicle. Always stow the Tire Service Kit in
the place provided. Failure to follow these warnings can result in injuries that are serious or fatal to
you, your passengers, and others around you.
• Take care not to allow the contents of Tire Service
Kit to come in contact with hair, eyes, or clothing.
Tire Service Kit sealant is harmful if inhaled,
swallowed, or absorbed through the skin. It causes
skin, eye, and respiratory irritation. Flush immediately with plenty of water if there is any contact
with eyes or skin. Change clothing as soon as
possible, if there is any contact with clothing.
• Tire Service Kit Sealant solution contains latex. In
case of an allergic reaction or rash, consult a physician immediately. Keep Tire Service Kit out of
reach of children. If swallowed, rinse mouth immediately with plenty of water and drink plenty of
water. Do not induce vomiting! Consult a physician
immediately.
(Continued)
Sealing A Tire With Tire Service Kit
(A) Whenever You Stop To Use Tire Service Kit:
1. Pull over to a safe location and turn on the vehicle’s
Hazard Warning flashers.
2. Verify that the valve stem (on the wheel with the
deflated tire) is in a position that is near to the ground.
This will allow the Tire Service Kit Hoses (6) and (7) to
reach the valve stem and keep the Tire Service Kit flat
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 269
on the ground. This will provide the best positioning 4. Remove the cap from the valve stem and then screw
the fitting at the end of the Sealant Hose (6) onto the
of the kit when injecting the sealant into the deflated
valve stem.
tire and running the air pump. Move the vehicle as
necessary to place the valve stem in this position
5. Uncoil the Power Plug (8) and insert the plug into the
before proceeding.
vehicle’s 12 Volt power outlet.
3. Place the transmission in PARK (auto transmission) or
NOTE: Do not remove foreign objects (e.g., screws or
in Gear (manual transmission) and place the ignition
nails) from the tire.
in the OFF position.
(C) Injecting Tire Service Kit Sealant Into The
4. Set the parking brake.
Deflated Tire:
(B) Setting Up To Use Tire Service Kit:
• Always start the engine before turning ON the Tire
Service Kit.
1. Push in the Mode Select Knob (5) and turn to the
Sealant Mode position.
NOTE: Manual transmission vehicles must have the
2. Uncoil the Sealant Hose (6) and then remove the cap parking brake engaged and the shift lever in NEUTRAL.
from the fitting at the end of the hose.
• After pushing the Power Button (4), the sealant (white
3. Place the Tire Service Kit flat on the ground next to the
fluid) will flow from the Sealant Bottle (1) through the
Sealant Hose (6) and into the tire.
deflated tire.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
6
270 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
NOTE: Sealant may leak out through the puncture in the NOTE: If the Mode Select Knob (5) is on Air Mode and
tire.
the pump is operating, air will dispense from the Air
Pump Hose (7) only, not the Sealant Hose (6).
If the sealant (white fluid) does not flow within 0 – 10
seconds through the Sealant Hose (6):
If the sealant (white fluid) does flow through the
Sealant Hose (6):
1. Push the Power Button (4) to turn Off the Tire Service
Kit. Disconnect the Sealant Hose (6) from the valve 1. Continue to operate the pump until sealant is no
stem. Make sure the valve stem is free of debris.
longer flowing through hose (typically takes 30 - 70
Reconnect the Sealant Hose (6) to the valve stem.
seconds). As the sealant flows through the Sealant
Check that the Mode Select Knob (5) is in the Sealant
Hose (6), the Pressure Gauge (3) can read as high as 70
Mode position and not Air Mode. Push the Power
psi (4.8 Bar). The Pressure Gauge (3) will decrease
Button (4) to turn On the Tire Service Kit.
quickly from approximately 70 psi (4.8 Bar) to the
actual tire pressure when the Sealant Bottle (1) is
2. Connect the Power Plug (8) to a different 12 Volt
empty.
power outlet in your vehicle or another vehicle, if
available. Make sure the engine is running before 2. The pump will start to inject air into the tire immediturning ON the Tire Service Kit.
ately after the Sealant Bottle (1) is empty. Continue to
operate the pump and inflate the tire to the pressure
3. The Sealant Bottle (1) may be empty due to previous
indicated on the tire pressure label on the driver-side
use. Call for assistance.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 271
latch pillar (recommended pressure). Check the tire 3. Immediately disconnect the Sealant Hose (6) from the
pressure by looking at the Pressure Gauge (3).
valve stem, reinstall the cap on the fitting at the end of
the hose, and place the Tire Service Kit in the vehicle
If the tire does not inflate to at least 26 psi (1.8 Bar)
storage location. Quickly proceed to (D) “Drive Vepressure within 15 minutes:
hicle.”
• The tire is too badly damaged. Do not attempt to drive
the vehicle further. Call for assistance.
CAUTION!
NOTE: If the tire becomes over-inflated, push the Deflation Button to reduce the tire pressure to the recommended inflation pressure before continuing.
If the tire inflates to the recommended pressure or is at
least 26 psi (1.8 Bar) pressure within 15 minutes:
1. Push the Power Button (4) to turn off the Tire Service
Kit.
• The metal end fitting from Power Plug (8) may get
hot after use, so it should be handled carefully.
• Failure to reinstall the cap on the fitting at the end
of the Sealant Hose (6) can result in sealant contacting your skin, clothing, and the vehicle’s interior. It can also result in sealant contacting internal
Tire Service Kit components which may cause
permanent damage to the kit.
2. Remove the Speed Limit sticker from the top of the
Sealant Bottle (1) and place the sticker on the instrument panel.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
6
272 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
(D) Drive Vehicle:
(E) After Driving:
Immediately after injecting sealant and inflating the tire, Pull over to a safe location. Refer to “Whenever You Stop
drive the vehicle 5 miles (8 km) or 10 minutes to ensure to Use Tire Service Kit” before continuing.
distribution of the Tire Service Kit Sealant within the tire.
1. Push in the Mode Select Knob (5) and turn to the Air
Do not exceed 55 mph (90 km/h).
Mode position.
WARNING!
Tire Service Kit is not a permanent flat tire repair.
Have the tire inspected and repaired or replaced after
using Tire Service Kit. Do not exceed 55 mph (90
km/h) until the tire is repaired or replaced. Failure to
follow this warning can result in injuries that are
serious or fatal to you, your passengers, and others
around you.
2. Uncoil the power plug and insert the plug into the
vehicle’s 12 Volt power outlet.
3. Uncoil the Air Pump Hose (7) (black in color) and
screw the fitting at the end of hose (7) onto the valve
stem.
4. Check the pressure in the tire by reading the Pressure
Gauge (3).
If tire pressure is less than 19 psi (1.3 Bar):
The tire is too badly damaged. Do not attempt to drive
the vehicle further. Call for assistance.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 273
If the tire pressure is 19 psi (1.3 Bar) or higher:
5. Remove the Speed Limit sticker from the instrument
panel after the tire has been repaired.
1. Push the Power Button (4) to turn on Tire Service Kit
and inflate the tire to the pressure indicated on the tire 6. Replace the Sealant Bottle (1) and Sealant Hose (6)
and loading information label on the driver-side door
assembly at your authorized dealer as soon as posopening.
sible. Refer to (F) “Sealant Bottle and Hose Replacement”.
NOTE: If the tire becomes over-inflated, push the Deflation Button to reduce the tire pressure to the recom- NOTE: When having the tire serviced, advise the authomended inflation pressure before continuing.
rized dealer or service center that the tire has been sealed
using the Tire Service Kit.
2. Disconnect the Tire Service Kit from the valve stem,
reinstall the cap on the valve stem and unplug from 12 (F) Sealant Bottle And Hose Replacement:
Volt outlet.
1. Uncoil the Sealant Hose (6) (clear in color).
3. Place the Tire Service Kit in its proper storage area in
2. Locate the round Sealant Bottle release button in the
the vehicle.
recessed area under the sealant bottle.
4. Have the tire inspected and repaired or replaced at the
3. Push the Sealant Bottle release button. The Sealant
earliest opportunity at an authorized dealer or tire
Bottle (1) will pop up. Remove the bottle and dispose
service center.
of it accordingly.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
6
274 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
4. Clean any remaining sealant from the Tire Service Kit pack. Jump-starting can be dangerous if done improperly
so please follow the procedures in this section carefully.
housing.
5. Position the new Sealant Bottle (1) in the housing so NOTE: When using a portable battery booster pack,
that the Sealant Hose (6) aligns with the hose slot in follow the manufacturer’s operating instructions and
the front of the housing. Push the bottle into the precautions.
housing. An audible click will be heard indicating the
bottle is locked into place.
WARNING!
6. Verify that the cap is installed on the fitting at the end
of the Sealant Hose (6) and return the hose to its
storage area (located on the bottom of the air pump).
Do not attempt jump-starting if the battery is frozen.
It could rupture or explode and cause personal injury.
7. Return the Tire Service Kit to its storage location in the
vehicle.
CAUTION!
JUMP-STARTING PROCEDURE (12 VOLT
BATTERY ONLY)
If your vehicle has a discharged 12 Volt battery, it can be
jump-started using a set of jumper cables and a battery in
another vehicle or by using a portable battery booster
Do not use a portable battery booster pack or any
other booster source with a system voltage greater
than 12 Volts or damage to the battery, power electronics or electrical system may occur.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 275
Preparations For Jump-Start
The battery in your vehicle is located in the underhood
compartment under the beauty cover. To access the
battery pull upward on the cover.
6
Battery Posts
1 — Positive (+) Post (Covered With Protective Cap)
2 — Negative (-) Post
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
276 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
3. Remove the protective cover over the positive (+)
battery post.
WARNING!
• Take care to avoid the radiator cooling fan whenever the hood is raised. It can start anytime the
ignition switch is ON. You can be injured by
moving fan blades.
• Remove any metal jewelry such as rings, watch
bands and bracelets that could make an inadvertent
electrical contact. You could be seriously injured.
• Batteries contain sulfuric acid that can burn your
skin or eyes and generate hydrogen gas which is
flammable and explosive. Keep open flames or
sparks away from the battery.
1. Set the parking brake, place the transmission into
PARK and turn the ignition to LOCK.
2. Turn off the heater, radio, and all unnecessary electrical accessories.
4. If using another vehicle to jump-start the battery, park
the vehicle within the jumper cables reach, set the
parking brake and make sure the ignition is OFF.
WARNING!
Do not allow vehicles to touch each other as this
could establish a ground connection and personal
injury could result.
Jump-Starting Procedure
WARNING!
Failure to follow this jump-starting procedure could
result in personal injury or property damage due to
battery explosion.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 277
CAUTION!
Failure to follow these procedures could result in
damage to the charging system of the booster vehicle
or the discharged vehicle.
4. Connect the opposite end of the negative (-) jumper
cable to a good engine ground (exposed metal part of
the discharged vehicle underhood compartment)
away from the battery.
WARNING!
Connecting The Jumper Cables
1. Connect the positive (+) end of the jumper cable to the
positive (+) post of the discharged vehicle.
2. Connect the opposite end of the positive (+) jumper
cable to the positive (+) post of the booster battery.
Do not connect the jumper cable to the negative (-) post
of the discharged battery. The resulting electrical spark
could cause the battery to explode and could result in
personal injury. Only use the specific ground point, do
not use any other exposed metal parts.
3. Connect the negative end (-) of the jumper cable to the 5. Start the engine in the vehicle that has the booster
negative (-) post of the booster battery.
battery, let the engine idle a few minutes, and then
turn the key to RUN position on the vehicle with the
discharged battery.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
6
278 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
6. Once the vehicle is started, remove the jumper cables FREEING A STUCK VEHICLE
in the reverse sequence:
If your vehicle becomes stuck in mud, sand or snow, it
can often be moved using a rocking motion. Turn the
Disconnecting The Jumper Cables
steering wheel right and left to clear the area around the
1. Disconnect the negative (-) jumper cable from the
front wheels. Then shift back and forth between DRIVE
engine ground (-) of the vehicle with the discharged
and REVERSE while gently pushing the accelerator. Use
battery.
the least amount of accelerator pedal pressure that will
2. Disconnect the negative end (-) of the jumper cable maintain the rocking motion, without spinning the
wheels.
from the negative (-) post of the booster battery.
3. Disconnect the opposite end of the positive (+) jumper NOTE: Push the ⬙ESC Off⬙ switch, to place the Electronic
cable from the positive (+) post of the booster battery. Stability Control (ESC) system in ⬙Partial Off⬙ mode,
before rocking the vehicle. Refer to “Electronic Brake
4. Disconnect the positive (+) end of the jumper cable
Control” in “Starting And Operating” for further inforfrom the positive (+) post of the discharged vehicle.
mation. Once the vehicle has been freed, push the ⬙ESC
If frequent jump-starting is required to start your vehicle, Off⬙ switch again to restore ⬙ESC On⬙ mode.
you should have the battery and charging system inspected at your authorized dealer.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 279
CAUTION!
WARNING! (Continued)
• When “rocking” a stuck vehicle by shifting between DRIVE and REVERSE, do not spin the
wheels faster than 15 mph (24 km/h), or drivetrain
damage may result.
• Spinning the wheels too fast may lead to transmission overheating and failure. It can also damage the
tires. Do not spin the wheels above 30 mph
(48 km/h) while in gear.
longer than 30 seconds continuously without stopping when you are stuck and do not let anyone near
a spinning wheel, no matter what the speed.
WARNING!
Fast spinning tires can be dangerous. Forces generated by excessive wheel speeds may cause damage, or
even failure, of the axle and tires. A tire could
explode and injure someone. Do not spin your vehicle’s wheels faster than 30 mph (48 km/h) or for
MANUAL PARK RELEASE
WARNING!
Always secure your vehicle by fully applying the
parking brake, before activating the Manual Park
Release. Activating the Manual Park Release will
allow your vehicle to roll away if it is not secured by
the parking brake or other means. Activating the
Manual Park Release on an unsecured vehicle could
lead to serious injury or death for those in or around
the vehicle.
(Continued)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
6
280 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
In order to move the vehicle in cases where the transmission will not shift out of PARK (such as a dead battery),
a Manual Park Release is available. If a dead 12 volt
battery is the cause of the condition refer to “Jump Start
Procedure — 12 Volt Battery” before performing the
Manual Park Release.
To perform the Manual Park Release follow these steps:
• To prevent the vehicle from rolling unintentionally,
firmly apply the parking brake.
• If possible, raise the front driver’s side of the vehicle to
provide access to the transmission.
Manual Park Release Location
• Working from underneath the vehicle, remove the black
• Reinstall the rubber plug.
rubber plug from the front of the Park module (a black
• Release the parking brake only when a driver is in the
canister mounted on the front of the transmission).
vehicle, or the vehicle is secured by other means. The
• Using a T25 driver bit, rotate the Manual Park Release
Manual Park Release will be reset automatically once
shaft (located just behind the rubber plug) clockwise,
the vehicle is restarted.
at least 20 turns, to release the Park mechanism. The
vehicle is now out of PARK and can be moved.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 281
TOWING A DISABLED VEHICLE
This section describes procedures for towing a disabled vehicle using a commercial towing service.
Towing Condition
Flat Tow
Wheel Lift
Flatbed
Wheels OFF The Ground
NONE
Rear
Front
ALL
6
This vehicle must be towed with the front wheels OFF the
ground.
If you must use the accessories (wipers, defrosters, etc.)
while being towed, the ignition must be in the ON/RUN
position.
If the ignition key is unavailable, or the battery is
discharged, see “Manual Park Release” in “What To Do
In Emergencies” for instructions on shifting the transmission out of PARK in order to move the vehicle.
SINGLE-SPEED TRANSMISSION
NOT ALLOWED
NOT ALLOWED
OK
OK
CAUTION!
• Do not use sling-type equipment when towing.
Vehicle damage may occur.
• When securing the vehicle to a flatbed truck, do not
attach to front or rear suspension components.
Damage to your vehicle may result from improper
towing.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CONTENTS
䡵 UNDERHOOD COMPARTMENT . . . . . . . . . . .285
▫ Selection Of Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .291
䡵 REPLACEMENT PARTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286
▫ Adding Coolant. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .292
䡵 DEALER SERVICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286
▫ Power Electronics and Battery Thermal
Management Systems — Drain, Flush And
Refill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .293
䡵 MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES . . . . . . . . . . .286
▫ Power Electronics And Battery Thermal
Management Systems. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .288
▫ Power Electronics and Battery Thermal
Management Systems — Coolant Level
Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .288
▫ Power Electronics and Battery Thermal
Management Systems — Cooling Pressure
Caps. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .290
▫ Disposal Of Used Power Electronics and Battery
Thermal Management Systems Coolant . . . . . .293
▫ Points To Remember . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .294
▫ Maintenance-Free Battery 12 Volt . . . . . . . . . .294
▫ Air Conditioner Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . .295
▫ Body Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
7
284 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
▫ Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
▫ Headlamps Low Beam and High Beam . . . . . .318
▫ Adding Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299
▫ Front Turn Signal, Parking And Daytime
Running Lamps. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .318
▫ Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .300
▫ Appearance Care And Protection From
Corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .302
䡵 FUSES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .309
▫ Interior Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .310
▫ Power Distribution Center #1 . . . . . . . . . . . . .312
▫ Power Distribution Center (PDC) #2 . . . . . . . .315
䡵 VEHICLE STORAGE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316
▫ Front Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .319
▫ Front/Rear Side Marker Lamps. . . . . . . . . . . .319
▫ Rear Tail, Stop, Backup And Turn Signal
Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .319
▫ Center High Mounted Stop Lamp (CHMSL). . .320
䡵 FLUID CAPACITIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .320
䡵 FLUIDS, LUBES, AND GENUINE PARTS . . . . .321
䡵 REPLACEMENT BULBS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316
䡵 BULB REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .317
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 285
UNDERHOOD COMPARTMENT
7
1 — Battery Thermal Coolant Reservoir
2 — Power Electronics Coolant Reservoir
3 — Brake Fluid Reservoir
4 — Fuses
5 — 12V Battery
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
286 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: Intentional tampering with emissions control
systems may void your warranty and could result in civil
Use of genuine parts for normal/scheduled maintenance
penalties being assessed against you.
and repairs is highly recommended to ensure the designed performance. Damage or failures caused by the
WARNING!
use of parts which are not quality-equivalent to genuine
parts for maintenance and repairs will not be covered by You can be badly injured working on or around a
the manufacturer’s warranty.
motor vehicle. Only do service work for which you
REPLACEMENT PARTS
DEALER SERVICE
have the knowledge and the proper equipment. If
you have any doubt about your ability to perform a
service job, take your vehicle to a competent mechanic.
Your authorized dealer has the qualified service personnel, special tools, and equipment to perform all service
operations in an expert manner. Service Manuals are
available which include detailed service information for MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES
your vehicle. Refer to these Service Manuals before
attempting any procedure yourself.
WARNING!
Your vehicle has both a high voltage DC and AC
system as well as a 12 Volt system. DC and AC high
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
(Continued)
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 287
WARNING! (Continued)
voltage are both extremely dangerous and can cause
severe burns, electric shock, serious injury or even
death. In order to avoid personal injuries:
• DO NOT TOUCH THE HIGH VOLTAGE CABLES
(ORANGE COLORED) AND/OR THE CONNECTORS.
• Follow all Caution and Warning labels attached to
the High Voltage components.
• Do not remove or replace any of the 500e System
components. All replacement or repairs of 500e
System components should be performed by a
factory-trained technician at an authorized dealer.
The pages that follow contain the required maintenance
services determined by the engineers who designed your
vehicle.
Besides those maintenance items specified in the fixed
maintenance schedule, there are other components which
may require servicing or replacement in the future.
CAUTION!
• Failure to properly maintain your vehicle or perform repairs and service when necessary could
result in more costly repairs, damage to other
components or negatively impact vehicle performance. Immediately have potential malfunctions
examined by an authorized dealer or qualified
repair center.
• Your vehicle has been built with improved fluids
that protect the performance and durability of your
vehicle and also allow extended maintenance intervals. Do not use chemical flushes in these components as the chemicals can damage them. Such
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
(Continued)
7
288 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION! (Continued)
damage is not covered by the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty. If a flush is needed because of component malfunction, use only the specified fluid for
the flushing procedure.
temperature, the level of the coolant (antifreeze) in the
bottles should be between the bottom and top lines
marked “MIN-MAX FILL RANGE”.
Power Electronics And Battery Thermal
Management Systems
The Power Electronics and Battery Thermal Management
Systems are completely separate and designed to regulate temperature for the high voltage battery and the
electric components.
Power Electronics and Battery Thermal
Management Systems — Coolant Level Check
Coolant MIN/MAX
The coolant expansion bottles provides a quick visual As long as the vehicle operating temperature is satisfacmethod for determining that the coolant level is ad- tory, the coolant bottles need only be checked once a
equate. With the vehicle off and coolant at ambient month.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 289
When additional coolant (antifreeze) is needed to main- Check the front of the A/C condenser for any accumutain the proper level, it should be added to the coolant lation of bugs, leaves, etc. If dirty, clean by gently
spraying water from a garden hose vertically down the
bottles. Do not overfill.
face of the condenser.
Check the Power Electronics and Battery Thermal Management Systems coolant (antifreeze) protection every 12 NOTE: DO NOT REMOVE THE COOLANT PRESSURE
months (before the onset of freezing weather, where CAP WHEN THE COOLING SYSTEM IS HOT.
applicable).
Maintain coolant (antifreeze) concentration at a minimum of 50% MOPAR Antifreeze/Coolant 10 Year/
150,000 Mile Formula OAT (Organic Additive Technology) and distilled/deionized water for proper corrosion
protection.
Check the coolant bottles tubing for brittle rubber, cracking, tears, cuts and tightness of the connection at the
bottles and radiator. Inspect the entire system for leaks.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
7
290 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING! (Continued)
hear steam coming from under the hood, do not open
the hood until the radiator has had time to cool.
Never try to open a cooling system pressure cap
when the radiator is hot.
Power Electronics and Battery Thermal
Management Systems — Cooling Pressure Caps
The caps must be fully tightened to prevent loss of
coolant (antifreeze).
The caps should be inspected and cleaned if there is any
accumulation of foreign material on the sealing surfaces.
NOTE:
WARNING!
You or others can be badly burned by hot coolant
(antifreeze) or steam from your radiator. If you see or
(Continued)
• The pressure caps on the reservoirs are unique and
rated at 5 PSI caps.
• Use only MOPAR replacement parts.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 291
WARNING!
CAUTION!
• The warning words “DO NOT OPEN HOT” on the
cooling system pressure cap are a safety precaution.
Never add coolant (antifreeze) when the cooling
system is overheated. Do not loosen or remove the
cap to cool an overheated cooling system. Heat
causes pressure to build up in the cooling system.
To prevent scalding or injury, do not remove the
pressure cap while the system is hot or under
pressure.
• Do not use a pressure cap other than the one
specified for your vehicle. Personal injury or vehicle damage may result.
• Mixing of coolant (antifreeze) other than specified
Organic Additive Technology (OAT) coolant (antifreeze), may result in cooling system damage and
may decrease corrosion protection. Organic Additive Technology (OAT) coolant is different and
should not be mixed with Hybrid Organic Additive
Technology (HOAT) coolant (antifreeze). If a nonOAT coolant (antifreeze) is introduced into the
cooling system in an emergency, it should be replaced with the specified coolant (antifreeze) as
soon as possible.
• Do not use water alone or alcohol-based coolant
(antifreeze) products. Do not use additional rust
inhibitors or antirust products, as they may not be
compatible with the radiator coolant and may plug
the radiator.
Selection Of Coolant
Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, And Genuine Parts” in
“Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further information.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
(Continued)
7
292 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
When adding coolant (antifreeze):
CAUTION! (Continued)
• This vehicle has not been designed for use with
propylene glycol-based coolant (antifreeze). Use of
propylene glycol-based coolant (antifreeze) is not
recommended.
• The manufacturer recommends using MOPAR
Antifreeze/Coolant 10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula
OAT (Organic Additive Technology).
• Mix a minimum solution of 50% OAT coolant (antifreeze) and distilled water. Use higher concentrations
Adding Coolant
(not to exceed 70%) if temperatures below -34ºF (-37ºC)
Your vehicle has been built with cooling systems that
are anticipated.
allow extended maintenance intervals. This coolant (an• Use only high purity water such as distilled or deiontifreeze) can be used up to ten years or 150,000 miles
ized water when mixing the water and coolant (anti(240,000 km) before replacement. To prevent reducing
freeze) solution. The use of lower quality water will
this extended maintenance period, it is important that
reduce the amount of corrosion protection in the
you use the same coolant (antifreeze) throughout the life
cooling systems.
of your vehicle.
Please note that it is the owner’s responsibility to mainPlease review these recommendations for using Organic
tain the proper level of protection against freezing acAdditive Technology (OAT) coolant (antifreeze).
cording to the temperatures occurring in the area where
the vehicle is operated.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 293
NOTE: Mixing coolant (antifreeze) types will decrease
the life of the Power Electronics and Battery Thermal
Management Systems coolant (antifreeze) and will require more frequent coolant (antifreeze) changes.
Power Electronics and Battery Thermal
Management Systems — Drain, Flush And Refill
CAUTION!
It is recommended to have the cooling systems serviced at your authorized dealer. Failure to do so could
result in poor cooling system performance and/or
vehicle damage.
Refer to “Maintenance Schedules” in Section 7 of this Disposal Of Used Power Electronics and Battery
Thermal Management Systems Coolant
supplement for the proper maintenance intervals.
If the coolant (antifreeze) is dirty or contains a considerable amount of sediment, clean and flush with a reliable
cooling system cleaner. Follow with a thorough rinsing to
remove all deposits and chemicals. Properly dispose of
old coolant (antifreeze) solution.
Used antifreeze is a regulated substance requiring proper
disposal. Check with your local authorities to determine
the disposal rules for your community. To prevent ingestion by animals or children, do not store antifreeze in
open containers or allow it to remain in puddles on the
ground. If ingested by a child, contact a physician
immediately. Clean up any ground spills immediately.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
7
294 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
• Make sure that the coolant control systems recovery
bottles overflow hoses are not kinked or obstructed.
Points To Remember
If an examination of your underhood compartment
shows no evidence of cooler or hose leaks, the vehicle • Keep the front of the coolant control systems clean. If
may be safely driven.
your vehicle is equipped with air conditioning, keep
the front of the condenser clean.
• Do not overfill the coolant recovery bottles.
Maintenance-Free Battery 12 Volt
• Check coolant (antifreeze) freeze point in the coolant
recovery bottles. If coolant (antifreeze) needs to be Your vehicle is equipped with a maintenance-free 12 Volt
added, contents of coolant recovery bottles must also battery. You will never have to add water, nor is periodic
maintenance required.
be protected against freezing.
• If frequent coolant (antifreeze) additions are required,
or if the level in the coolant recovery bottles does not
drop when the engine cools, the cooling system should
be pressure tested for leaks.
• Maintain coolant (antifreeze) concentration at 50%
OAT coolant (antifreeze) (minimum) and distilled/
deionized water for proper corrosion protection of
your engine which contains aluminum components.
WARNING!
• Battery fluid is a corrosive acid solution and can
burn or even blind you. Do not allow battery fluid
to contact your eyes, skin, or clothing. Do not lean
over a battery when attaching clamps. If acid
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
(Continued)
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 295
WARNING! (Continued)
CAUTION!
splashes in eyes or on skin, flush the area immediately with large amounts of water. Refer to
“Jump-Starting Procedures” in “What To Do In
Emergencies” for further information.
• Battery gas is flammable and explosive. Keep
flame or sparks away from the battery. Do not use
a booster battery or any other booster source with
an output greater than 12 Volts. Do not allow cable
clamps to touch each other.
• Battery posts, terminals, and related accessories
contain lead and lead compounds. Wash hands
after handling.
• The battery in this vehicle has a vent hose that
should not be disconnected and should only be
replaced with a battery of the same type (vented).
• It is essential when replacing the cables on the
battery that the positive cable is attached to the
positive post and the negative cable is attached to
the negative post. Battery posts are marked positive
(+) and negative (-) and are identified on the
battery case. Cable clamps should be tight on the
terminal posts and free of corrosion.
• If a 12 Volt Low Voltage Battery System “fast
charger” is used while the battery is in the vehicle,
disconnect both vehicle battery cables before connecting the charger to the battery. Do not use a “fast
charger” to provide starting voltage.
Air Conditioner Maintenance
For best possible performance, your air conditioner
should be checked and serviced by an authorized dealer
at the start of each warm season. This service should
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
7
296 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
include cleaning of the condenser fins and air conditioning performance tests.
CAUTION!
Do not use chemical flushes in your air conditioning
system as the chemicals can damage your air conditioning components. Such damage is not covered by
the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
WARNING! (Continued)
Warranty Information Book, located on the DVD,
for further warranty information.
• The air conditioning system contains refrigerant
under high pressure. To avoid risk of personal
injury or damage to the system, adding refrigerant
or any repair requiring lines to be disconnected
should be done by an experienced technician.
Body Lubrication
WARNING!
• Use only refrigerants and compressor lubricants
approved by the manufacturer for your air conditioning system. Some unapproved refrigerants are
flammable and can explode, injuring you. Other
unapproved refrigerants or lubricants can cause the
system to fail, requiring costly repairs. Refer to
(Continued)
Locks and all body pivot points, including such items as
seat tracks, door hinge pivot points and rollers, liftgate,
tailgate, decklid, sliding doors and hood hinges, should
be lubricated periodically with a lithium based grease,
such as MOPAR Spray White Lube to assure quiet, easy
operation and to protect against rust and wear. Prior to
the application of any lubricant, the parts concerned
should be wiped clean to remove dust and grit; after
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 297
lubricating excess oil and grease should be removed.
Particular attention should also be given to hood latching
components to ensure proper function. When performing
other underhood services, the hood latch, release mechanism and safety catch should be cleaned and lubricated.
The external lock cylinders should be lubricated twice a
year, preferably in the Fall and Spring. Apply a small
amount of a high quality lubricant, such as MOPAR Lock
Cylinder Lubricant directly into the lock cylinder.
Wiper Blades
Clean the rubber edges of the wiper blades and the
windshield and rear window periodically with a sponge
or soft cloth and a mild nonabrasive cleaner. This will
remove accumulations of salt, waxes, or road film, and
help reduce streaking and smearing.
Operation of the wipers on dry glass for long periods
may cause deterioration of the wiper blades. Always use
washer fluid when using the wipers to remove salt or dirt
from a dry windshield or rear window.
Avoid using the wiper blades to remove frost or ice from
the windshield or rear window. Make sure that they are
not frozen to the glass before turning them on to avoid
damaging the blade. Keep the blade rubber out of contact
with petroleum products.
NOTE: Life expectancy of wiper blades varies depending
on geographical area and frequency of use. Poor performance of blades may be present with chattering, marks,
water lines or wet spots. If any of these conditions are
present, clean the wiper blades or replace as necessary.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
7
298 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Rear Wiper Blade Removal/Installation
NOTE: The rear wiper arm cannot be raised fully upward unless the pivot cap is raised first.
1. Lift the pivot cap on the rear wiper arm upward, this
will allow the rear wiper blade to be raised off of the 2. Lift the rear wiper arm upward to raise the wiper
liftgate glass.
blade off of the liftgate glass.
3. Grab the bottom of the wiper blade and rotate it
forward to unsnap the blade pivot pin from the wiper
blade holder.
1 — Wiper Arm
2 — Pivot Cap
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 299
5. Lower the wiper blade and snap the pivot cap into
place.
Adding Washer Fluid
The windshield washer fluid reservoir is located in the
underhood compartment, and the fluid level should be
checked at regular intervals. Fill the reservoir with windshield washer solvent (not coolant/ antifreeze). Refer to
“Underhood Compartment” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further information.
WARNING!
1
2
3
4
—
—
—
—
Wiper Blade
Blade Pivot Pin
Wiper Arm
Wiper Blade Holder
Commercially available windshield washer solvents
are flammable. They could ignite and burn you. Care
must be exercised when filling or working around
the washer solution.
4. Install the wiper blade pivot pin into the wiper blade
holder at the end of the wiper arm, and firmly press
the wiper blade until it snaps into place.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
7
300 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Brake System
Brake Master Cylinder
In order to assure brake system performance, all brake
system components should be inspected periodically.
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
maintenance intervals.
The fluid level in the master cylinder should be checked
when performing under hood services, or immediately if
the “Brake Warning Light” is on and the parking brake is
not applied.
WARNING!
Riding the brakes can lead to brake failure and
possibly a collision. Driving with your foot resting or
riding on the brake pedal can result in abnormally
high brake temperatures, excessive lining wear, and
possible brake damage. Riding the brakes may also
reduce braking capacity in an emergency.
Be sure to clean the top of the master cylinder area before
removing the cap. If necessary, add fluid to bring the
fluid level up to the requirements described on the brake
fluid reservoir. Fluid level can be expected to fall as the
brake pads wear. The brake fluid level should be checked
when the pads are replaced. However, low fluid level
may be caused by a leak and a checkup may be needed.
NOTE:
Use only manufacturer’s recommended brake fluid. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, And Genuine Parts” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further information.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 301
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
• Use only manufacturer’s recommended brake
fluid. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, And Genuine
Parts” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further
information. Using the wrong type of brake fluid
can severely damage your brake system and/or
impair its performance. The proper type of brake
fluid for your vehicle is also identified on the
original factory installed hydraulic master cylinder
reservoir.
• To avoid contamination from foreign matter or
moisture, use only new brake fluid or fluid that has
been in a tightly closed container. Keep the master
cylinder reservoir cap secured at all times. Brake
fluid in a open container absorbs moisture from the
air resulting in a lower boiling point. This may
cause it to boil unexpectedly during hard or prolonged braking, resulting in sudden brake failure.
This could result in a collision.
• Overfilling the brake fluid reservoir can result in
spilling brake fluid on hot vehicle parts, causing
the brake fluid to catch fire. Brake fluid can also
damage painted and vinyl surfaces, care should be
taken to avoid its contact with these surfaces.
• Do not allow petroleum-based fluid to contaminate
the brake fluid. Brake seal components could be
damaged, causing partial or complete brake failure.
This could result in a collision.
(Continued)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
7
302 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
Use of improper brake fluids will affect overall
clutch system performance. Improper brake fluids
may damage the clutch system resulting in loss of
clutch function and the ability to shift the transmission.
hot or cold weather and other extreme conditions will
have an adverse effect on paint, metal trim, and underbody protection.
The following maintenance recommendations will enable
you to obtain maximum benefit from the corrosion
resistance built into your vehicle.
What Causes Corrosion?
Appearance Care And Protection From Corrosion
Protection Of Body And Paint From Corrosion
Vehicle body care requirements vary according to geographic locations and usage. Chemicals that make roads
passable in snow and ice and those that are sprayed on
trees and road surfaces during other seasons are highly
corrosive to the metal in your vehicle. Outside parking,
which exposes your vehicle to airborne contaminants,
road surfaces on which the vehicle is operated, extreme
Corrosion is the result of deterioration or removal of
paint and protective coatings from your vehicle.
The most common causes are:
• Road salt, dirt and moisture accumulation.
• Stone and gravel impact.
• Insects, tree sap and tar.
• Salt in the air near seacoast localities.
• Atmospheric fallout/industrial pollutants.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 303
Washing
• Wash your vehicle regularly. Always wash your vehicle in the shade using MOPAR Car Wash, or a mild
car wash soap, and rinse the panels completely with
clear water.
• If insects, tar, or other similar deposits have accumulated on your vehicle, use MOPAR Super Kleen Bug
and Tar Remover to remove.
CAUTION!
• Do not use abrasive or strong cleaning materials
such as steel wool or scouring powder that will
scratch metal and painted surfaces.
• Use of power washers exceeding 1,200 psi (8 274
kPa) can result in damage or removal of paint and
decals.
• Use a high quality cleaner wax, such as MOPAR Special Care
Cleaner Wax to remove road film, stains and to protect • If you drive on salted or dusty roads or if you drive
your paint finish. Take care never to scratch the paint.
near the ocean, hose off the undercarriage at least once
a month.
• Avoid using abrasive compounds and power buffing
that may diminish the gloss or thin out the paint finish. • It is important that the drain holes in the lower edges
of the doors, rocker panels, and trunk be kept clear and
open.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
7
304 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
• If you detect any stone chips or scratches in the paint, Wheel And Wheel Trim Care
touch them up immediately. The cost of such repairs is
• All wheels and wheel trim, especially aluminum and
considered the responsibility of the owner.
chrome plated wheels, should be cleaned regularly
• If your vehicle is damaged due to a collision or similar
with a mild soap and water to prevent corrosion.
cause that destroys the paint and protective coating,
• To remove heavy soil and/or excessive brake dust, use
have your vehicle repaired as soon as possible. The
MOPAR Wheel Cleaner.
cost of such repairs is considered the responsibility of
the owner.
NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with Dark Vapor or
• If you carry special cargo such as chemicals, fertilizers, Black Satin Chrome wheels DO NOT USE wheel cleaners,
de-icer salt, etc., be sure that such materials are well abrasives or polishing compounds. They will permanently damage this finish and such damage is not covpackaged and sealed.
ered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. USE ONLY
• If a lot of driving is done on gravel roads, consider MILD SOAP AND WATER WITH A SOFT CLOTH. Used
mud or stone shields behind each wheel.
on a regular basis this is all that is required to maintain
• Use MOPAR Touch Up Paint on scratches as soon as this finish.
possible. Your authorized dealer has touch up paint to
match the color of your vehicle.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 305
CAUTION!
Do not use scouring pads, steel wool, a bristle brush,
or metal polishes. Do not use oven cleaner. These
products may damage the wheel’s protective finish.
Avoid automatic car washes that use acidic solutions
or harsh brushes that may damage the wheel’s protective finish. Only MOPAR Wheel Cleaner or
equivalent is recommended.
• For tough stains, apply MOPAR Total Clean, or a mild
soap solution to a clean, damp cloth and remove stain.
Use a fresh, damp towel to remove soap residue.
• For grease stains, apply MOPAR Multi-Purpose
Cleaner to a clean, damp cloth and remove stain. Use
a fresh, damp towel to remove soap residue.
• Do not use any harsh solvents or any other form of
protectants on Stain Repel products.
Interior Care
Stain Repel Fabric Cleaning Procedure — If
Equipped
Use MOPAR Total Clean to clean fabric upholstery and
Stain Repel seats may be cleaned in the following man- carpeting.
ner:
Use MOPAR Total Clean to clean vinyl upholstery.
• Remove as much of the stain as possible by blotting MOPAR Total Clean is specifically recommended for
with a clean, dry towel.
leather upholstery.
• Blot any remaining stain with a clean, damp towel.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
7
306 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Your leather upholstery can be best preserved by regular
cleaning with a damp soft cloth. Small particles of dirt
can act as an abrasive and damage the leather upholstery
and should be removed promptly with a damp cloth.
Stubborn soils can be removed easily with a soft cloth
and MOPAR Total Clean. Care should be taken to avoid
soaking your leather upholstery with any liquid. Please
do not use polishes, oils, cleaning fluids, solvents, detergents, or ammonia-based cleaners to clean your leather
upholstery. Application of a leather conditioner is not
required to maintain the original condition.
CAUTION!
Direct contact of air fresheners, insect repellents,
suntan lotions, or hand sanitizers to the plastic,
painted, or decorated surfaces of the interior may
cause permanent damage. Wipe away immediately.
CAUTION!
Damage caused by these type of products may not be
covered by your New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
WARNING!
CAUTION!
Do not use volatile solvents for cleaning purposes.
Many are potentially flammable, and if used in
closed areas they may cause respiratory harm.
Do not use Alcohol and Alcohol-based and/or Keton
based cleaning products to clean leather seats, as
damage to the seat may result.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 307
equipped with radio antennas. Do not use scrapers or
other sharp instrument that may scratch the elements.
Cleaning Headlights
Your vehicle has plastic headlights that are lighter and
less susceptible to stone breakage than glass headlights. When cleaning the rear view mirror, spray cleaner on the
towel or cloth that you are using. Do not spray cleaner
Plastic is not as scratch resistant as glass and therefore
directly on the mirror.
different lens cleaning procedures must be followed.
Instrument Panel Cover
To minimize the possibility of scratching the lenses and
reducing light output, avoid wiping with a dry cloth. To The instrument panel cover has a low glare surface which
remove road dirt, wash with a mild soap solution fol- minimizes reflections on the windshield. Do not use
protectants or other products which may cause undesirlowed by rinsing.
able reflections. Use soap and warm water to restore the
Do not use abrasive cleaning components, solvents, steel
low glare surface.
wool or other aggressive material to clean the lenses.
Glass Surfaces
All glass surfaces should be cleaned on a regular basis
with MOPAR Glass Cleaner, or any commercial
household-type glass cleaner. Never use an abrasive type
cleaner. Use caution when cleaning the inside rear window equipped with electric defrosters or windows
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
7
308 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
2. Dry with a soft cloth.
Instrument Panel Bezels
Seat Belt Maintenance
CAUTION!
When installing hanging air fresheners in your vehicle, read the installation instructions carefully.
Some air fresheners will damage the finish of
painted or decorated parts if allowed to directly
contact any surface.
Do not bleach, dye or clean the belts with chemical
solvents or abrasive cleaners. This will weaken the fabric.
Sun damage can also weaken the fabric.
If the belts need cleaning, use a mild soap solution or
lukewarm water. Do not remove the belts from the
vehicle to wash them. Dry with a soft cloth.
Cleaning Plastic Instrument Cluster Lenses
Replace the belts if they appear frayed or worn or if the
The lenses in front of the instruments in this vehicle are buckles do not work properly.
molded in clear plastic. When cleaning the lenses, care
must be taken to avoid scratching the plastic.
WARNING!
1. Clean with a wet soft cloth. A mild soap solution may
be used, but do not use high alcohol content or
abrasive cleaners. If soap is used, wipe clean with a
clean damp cloth.
A frayed or torn belt could rip apart in a collision and
leave you with no protection. Inspect the belt system
periodically, checking for cuts, frays, or loose parts.
(Continued)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 309
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
Damaged parts must be replaced immediately. Do not
disassemble or modify the system. Seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a collision if they have
been damaged (i.e., bent retractor, torn webbing, etc.).
• Before replacing a fuse, make sure that the ignition
is off and that all the other services are switched off
and/or disengaged.
• If the replaced fuse blows again, contact an authorized dealer.
• If a general protection fuse for safety systems (air
bag system, braking system), power unit systems
(engine system, gearbox system) or steering system
blows, contact an authorized dealer.
FUSES
WARNING!
• When replacing a blown fuse, always use an appropriate replacement fuse with the same amp rating as
the original fuse. Never replace a fuse with another
fuse of higher amp rating. Never replace a blown
fuse with metal wires or any other material. Failure
to use proper fuses may result in serious personal
injury, fire and/or property damage.
(Continued)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
7
310 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Interior Fuses
The interior fuse panel is part of the Body Control
Module (BCM) and is located on the driver’s side under
the instrument panel.
1
Vehicle
Fuse
Number
F12
2
F32
3
F53
4
F38
5
F36
Cavity
Fuse Panel
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Mini
Fuse
7.5 Amp
Brown
5 Amp
Tan
5 Amp
Tan
20 Amp
Yellow
10 Amp
Red
Description
Right Low Beam
Front and Rear Ceiling Lights Trunk and
Door Courtesy Lights
Instrument Panel
Node
Central Door Locking
Diagnostic Socket,
Climate Control System, Tire Pressure
Monitor, TCU
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 311
6
Vehicle
Fuse
Number
F43
7
F48
Cavity
8
F13
9
F50
10
F51
Mini
Fuse
20 Amp
Yellow
20 Amp
Yellow
7.5 Amp
Brown
7.5 Amp
Brown
5 Amp
Tan
Description
Cavity
Bi-Directional Washer
11
Vehicle
Fuse
Number
F37
Passenger Power
Window
Left Low Beam
12
F49
5 Amp
Tan
Airbag
13
F31
Climate Control System, Stop Light, Exterior Mirrors, Sunroof
Switch
14
5 Amp
Tan
20 Amp
Yellow
F47
Mini
Fuse
5 Amp
Tan
Description
Stop Light Switch,
Instrument Panel
Node
Exterior Mirror, Electric Mirror, Parking
Sensor, Sunroof Switch
Ignition, Climate Control, RDU and EVCU
Driver Power Window
The fuse for the heated mirrors is located behind an
access panel on the front of the Instrument Panel.
NOTE: This fuse is a single fuse attached directly to the
wire harness.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
7
312 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Power Distribution Center #1
The Power Distribution Center #1 is located on the right
side of the underhood compartment. To access the fuses,
remove locking screw and slide cover off.
F90 Fuse Location
1 — Heated Mirror Fuse
Cavity
F90
2 — Access Panel
Mini Fuse
5 Amp Tan
Description
Heated Mirrors
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Front Distribution Unit
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 313
The ID number of the electrical component corresponding to each fuse can be found on the back of the cover.
Cavity
F01
F02
F03
F04
F05
F06
Maxi
Fuse
60 Amp
Blue
20 Amp
Yellow
20 Amp
Yellow
40 Amp
Orange
70 Amp
Tan
60 Amp
Blue
F08
–
Body Control
Module (BCM)
Audio Amplifier
F09
Maxi
Fuse
40 Amp
Orange
40 Amp
Orange
–
–
Ignition Switch
F10
–
–
Brake System
Module Pump
Electric Power
Steering (EPS)
Radiator Fan
F11
–
F14
–
F15
–
Cavity
F07
Mini Fuse
–
–
–
Description
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Mini Fuse
–
–
5 Amp
Tan
10 Amp
Red
10 Amp
Red
5 Amp
Tan
15 Amp
Blue
Description
Regen Brake
Module
HVAC
Air Electric Heater
Charge Indicator
Horn
Electronic Vehicle
Control Unit
(EVCU)
High Beam (Shutter)
Cigar Lighter,
AUX Power Outlet
7
314 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
F16
Maxi
Fuse
–
F18
–
Cavity
F19
–
F20
–
F21
–
F23
–
Mini Fuse
10 Amp
Red
5 Amp
Tan
10 Amp
Red
15 Amp
Blue
20 Amp
Yellow
25 Amp
Clear
Humidity Sensor
VPAM
AC Compressor
Electronic Vehicle
Control Unit
(EVCU)
HVAC
F24
Maxi
Fuse
–
F30
–
F81
Heated Seats – If
Equipped
Radio
F84
30 Amp
Green
30 Amp
Green
–
Anti-Lock Brake
Valves
F87
Description
Cavity
F82
F85
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
30 Amp
Green
–
Mini Fuse
7.5 Amp
Brown
15 Amp
Blue
–
–
25 Amp
Clear
–
5 Amp
Tan
Description
EPS
YAW Sensor
Fog Lamps
Electronic Shifter
(ESM)
Sunroof
Regen Brake
Module
Rear Window
Heater
Electronic Shifter
(ESM)
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 315
Power Distribution Center (PDC) #2
Cavity
The Power Distribution Center #2 is located next to the
battery in the underhood compartment. To access the
fuses, pull the release tabs and remove the cover.
PDC #2
Mini Fuse
Description
FPT9
Maxi
Fuse
–
15 Amp
Blue
FPT13
–
10 Amp
Red
FPT16
–
FPT17
–
5 Amp
Tan
10 Amp
Red
FPT20
–
Battery Pack Control Module (BPCM)
Power Inverter
Module (PIM)
EAC (AC Compressor)
On Board Charging
Module (OBCM)
Intelligent Battery
Sensor (IBS)
EAC (AC Compressor)
Radiator Fan
Electronic Vehicle
Control Unit
(EVCU)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
10 Amp
Red
7
316 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Cavity
FPT3
Cartridge Fuse
25 Amp White
FPT5
20 Amp Lt. Blue
FPT6
40 Amp Green
Description
Battery Coolant
Pump
Inverter Coolant
Pump
Supply for fuses
F9, F13, F16, F17
and F20
VEHICLE STORAGE
Anytime you store your vehicle, or keep it out of service
(e.g., vacation) for two weeks or more, run the air
conditioning system at idle for about five minutes in the
fresh air and high blower setting. This will ensure
adequate system lubrication to minimize the possibility
of compressor damage when the air conditioning system
is started again.
REPLACEMENT BULBS
Interior Bulbs
The preferred way of storing your vehicle for a long
period of time is to leave it attached to a Level 1 or Level
2 charger. The vehicle has a wake-up feature that will
wake the system every 3 weeks and do a maintenance
charge on the 12 Volt battery and also top off the high
voltage battery if necessary.
Overhead Lamp
Courtesy Lamp
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Bulb Number
C5W
W5W
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 317
Exterior Bulbs
Front Low and High
Beam Headlamp
Front Parking/Daytime
Running Lamps
Front Fog Lamps
Front Side Marker Lamps
Front Turn Signal Lamps
Side Direction Lamps
Rear Turn Signal Lamps
Rear Side Marker Lamps
Rear Tail and Stop
Lamps
Rear Backup Lamps
Bulb Number
HIR2LL
Center High Mounted
Stop Lamp
License Plate Lamps
W21/5W
H11LL
W3W
WY21W
WY5W
PY21W
W3W
P21/5W
W16W
Bulb Number
LED (See Authorized
dealer)
LED (See Authorized
dealer)
NOTE: Numbers refer to commercial bulb types that
can be purchased from your authorized dealer.
If a bulb needs to be replaced, visit your authorized
dealer or refer to the applicable Service Manual.
BULB REPLACEMENT
NOTE: Lens fogging can occur under certain atmospheric conditions. This will usually clear as atmospheric
conditions change to allow the condensation to change
back into a vapor. Turning the lamps on will usually
accelerate the clearing process.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
7
318 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Headlamps Low Beam and High Beam
1. Remove the plastic cap from the back of the headlamp
housing.
2. Rotate the bulb counter-clockwise.
3. Remove the bulb and replace as needed.
4. Install the bulb and rotate clockwise to lock in place.
5. Reinstall the plastic cap.
Front Turn Signal, Parking And Daytime Running
Lamps
1. Turn the steering wheel completely to the left or right.
2. Open the wheel housing access door.
Wheel Housing Access Door
3. Remove the plastic cap from the back of the lamp
housing.
4. Rotate bulb/socket counter-clockwise.
5. Remove the bulb and replace as needed.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 319
6. Install the bulb into socket, and rotate bulb/socket Rear Tail, Stop, Backup And Turn Signal Lamps
clockwise into lamp locking it in place.
1. Open the liftgate.
7. Reinstall the plastic cap.
2. Remove the two screws and remove the tail lamp
Front Fog Lamps
assembly.
To replace the front fog lights, see your authorized dealer.
Front/Rear Side Marker Lamps
1. Remove portion of the wheel liner to allow hand
access to side marker lamp.
7
2. Rotate the bulb socket counterclockwise, and remove
the bulb and socket assembly from the housing.
3. Pull the bulb from the socket and insert the replacement bulb.
4. Install the bulb and socket assembly into the housing,
and rotate the socket clockwise to lock it in place.
5. Reinstall the wheel liner.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Tail Lamp Assembly Screws
320 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
3. Remove four screws and separate the backplate from 2.
the lamp housing.
3.
4. Remove the tail, stop, or turn signal bulbs by pushing
4.
them slightly and turning counter-clockwise.
5.
5. Remove the backup lamp bulb by pulling straight out.
6.
6. Replace lamps as required and reinstall lamp.
Remove the center high mounted stop lamp assembly.
Disconnect the electric connector.
Remove the two screws.
Replace the CHMSL assembly.
Reinstall the two screws.
Center High Mounted Stop Lamp (CHMSL)
1. Remove the two guard caps and the two fastening
screws.
FLUID CAPACITIES
Systems
Power Electronics Cooling System
Battery Thermal Management Cooling System
Single-Speed Transmission
U.S.
3.6 Quarts
7.0 Quarts
0.8 Quart
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Metric
3.5 Liters
6.7 Liters
750 ml
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 321
FLUIDS, LUBES, AND GENUINE PARTS
Component
Coolant
Brake Master Cylinder
Refrigerant
Compressor Lubricant
Single-Speed Transmission
Fluid, Lubricant, or Genuine Part
MOPAR Antifreeze/Coolant 10 Year/150,000 Mile
Formula OAT (Organic Additive Technology) or
equivalent meeting the requirements of
FCA Material Standard MS.90032.
MOPAR DOT 3, SAE J1703 should be used. If DOT 3,
SAE J1703 brake fluid is not available, then DOT 4 is
acceptable. Use only recommended brake fluids
or equivalent.
MOPAR R134a
MOPAR POE Oil or Equivalent meeting
the requirements of FCA Material Standard MS-12727
Castrol BOT 533
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
7
322 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Mixing of coolant (antifreeze) other than specified
Organic Additive Technology (OAT) coolant (antifreeze), may result in cooling system damage and
may decrease corrosion protection. Organic Additive Technology (OAT) coolant is different and
should not be mixed with Hybrid Organic Additive
Technology (HOAT) coolant (antifreeze). If a nonOAT coolant (antifreeze) is introduced into the
cooling system in an emergency, it should be replaced with the specified coolant (antifreeze) as
soon as possible.
• Do not use water alone or alcohol-based coolant
(antifreeze) products. Do not use additional rust
inhibitors or antirust products, as they may not be
compatible with the radiator coolant and may plug
the radiator.
• This vehicle has not been designed for use with
propylene glycol-based coolant (antifreeze). Use of
propylene glycol-based coolant (antifreeze) is not
recommended.
(Continued)
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
CONTENTS
䡵 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE . . . . . . . . . . . . .324
▫ Maintenance Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .324
8
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
324 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE
•
Once A Month Or Before A Trip:
• Check windshield washer fluid level
• Check the tire inflation pressures and look for unusual
wear or damage
• Check the fluid levels of the coolant reservoirs and
brake master cylinder
• Check function of all interior and exterior lights
•
•
•
At Every Service Interval:
Rotate the tires. Rotate at the first sign of irregular wear.
Inspect brake pads, shoes, rotors, drums, and
hoses.
Inspect battery cooling system protection and
hoses.
Check and adjust hand brake.
Maintenance Chart
Required Maintenance Intervals
Refer to the Maintenance Schedules on the following
Refer to the maintenance schedules on the following pages for the required maintenance intervals.
page for the required maintenance intervals.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Additional Inspections
Inspect the CV joints.
Inspect front suspension, tie rod
ends and boot seals, and
replace if necessary.
Inspect the brake linings.
Replace as necessary.
Inspect parking brake function.
Adjust as necessary.
30,000
40,000
50,000
60,000
70,000
80,000
90,000
100,000
110,000
120,000
130,000
140,000
150,000
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
48,000
64,000
80,000
96,000
112,000
128,000
144,000
160,000
176,000
192,000
208,000
224,000
240,000
Or Years:
Or Kilometers:
20,000
Mileage or time passed
(whichever comes first)
32,000
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 325
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
8
30,000
40,000
50,000
60,000
70,000
80,000
90,000
100,000
110,000
120,000
130,000
140,000
150,000
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
64,000
80,000
96,000
112,000
128,000
144,000
160,000
176,000
192,000
208,000
224,000
240,000
Additional Maintenance
Replace cabin air filter.
Clean and lube sun roof tracks.
Flush and replace the Power
Electronics and Battery Thermal
Loop Systems at 10 years or
150,000 miles (240,000 km)
whichever comes first.
2
48,000
Or Years:
Or Kilometers:
20,000
Mileage or time passed
(whichever comes first)
32,000
326 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
X
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 327
WARNING!
• You can be badly injured working on or around a
motor vehicle. Do only service work for which you
have the knowledge and the right equipment. If
you have any doubt about your ability to perform a
service job, take your vehicle to a competent mechanic.
• Failure to properly inspect and maintain your vehicle could result in a component malfunction and
effect vehicle handling and performance. This
could cause an accident.
8
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
CONTENTS
䡵 SUGGESTIONS FOR OBTAINING SERVICE FOR
YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .331
▫ Customer Assistance For The Hearing Or
Speech Impaired (TDD/TTY) . . . . . . . . . . . . .333
▫ Prepare For The Appointment. . . . . . . . . . . . .331
▫ Service Contract . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .333
▫ Prepare A List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .331 䡵 WARRANTY INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . .334
▫ Be Reasonable With Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . .331 䡵 REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS . . . . . . . . . . . .335
䡵 IF YOU NEED ASSISTANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . .331
▫ FIAT Customer Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .332
▫ FIAT Canada Customer Center . . . . . . . . . . . .332
▫ In Mexico Contact . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .332
▫ Puerto Rico And U.S. Virgin Islands . . . . . . . .333
▫ In The 50 United States And
Washington, D.C.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .335
▫ In Canada . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .335
䡵 PUBLICATION ORDER FORMS . . . . . . . . . . . .335
䡵 DEPARTMENT OF TRANSPORTATION
UNIFORM TIRE QUALITY GRADES . . . . . . . .337
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
9
330 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
▫ Treadwear. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .337
▫ Temperature Grades. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .338
▫ Traction Grades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .337
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 331
SUGGESTIONS FOR OBTAINING SERVICE FOR
YOUR VEHICLE
Prepare For The Appointment
Be Reasonable With Requests
If you list a number of items and you must have your
vehicle by the end of the day, discuss the situation with
the service advisor and list the items in order of priority.
At many authorized dealers, you may obtain a rental
vehicle at a minimal daily charge. If you need a rental, it
is advisable to make these arrangements when you call
for an appointment.
If you are having warranty work done, be sure to have
the right papers with you. Take your warranty folder. All
work to be performed may not be covered by the
warranty. Discuss additional charges with the service
manager. Keep a maintenance log of your vehicle’s
service history. This can often provide a clue to the IF YOU NEED ASSISTANCE
current problem.
The manufacturer and its authorized dealer are vitally
Prepare A List
interested in your satisfaction. We want you to be happy
Make a written list of your vehicle’s problems or the with our products and services.
specific work you want done. If you’ve had an accident Warranty service must be done by an authorized dealer.
or work done that is not on your maintenance log, let the We strongly recommend that you take the vehicle to an
service advisor know.
authorized dealer. They know your vehicle the best, and
are most concerned that you get prompt and high quality
service. The manufacturer’s authorized dealer have the
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
9
332 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
facilities, factory-trained technicians, special tools, and • Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
the latest information to ensure the vehicle is fixed • Vehicle delivery date and mileage
correctly and in a timely manner.
FIAT Customer Center
This is why you should always talk to an authorized
dealer service manager first. Most matters can be re- P.O. Box 21–8004 Auburn Hills, MI 48321–8004 Phone:
1-888-242-6342
solved with this process.
• If for some reason you are still not satisfied, talk to the FIAT Canada Customer Center
general manager or owner of the authorized dealer. P.O. Box 1621 Windsor, Ontario N9A 4H6 Phone: 1-800They want to know if you need assistance.
465-2001 (English) Phone: 1-800-387-9983 (French)
• If an authorized dealer is unable to resolve the concern,
In Mexico Contact
you may contact the manufacturer’s customer center.
Av. Prolongacion Paseo de la Reforma, 1240
Any communication to the manufacturer’s customer cenSante Fe C.P. 05109
ter should include the following information:
• Owner’s name and address
Mexico, D. F.
• Owner’s telephone number (home and office)
In Mexico City: 5081-7568
• Authorized dealer name
Outside Mexico City: 1-800-505-1300
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 333
San Juan 00919-1857
Canadian residents with hearing difficulties that require
assistance can use the special needs relay service offered
by Bell Canada. For TTY teletypewriter users, dial 711
and for Voice callers, dial 1-800-855-0511 to connect with
a Bell Relay Service operator.
Tel.: (787) 782-5757
Service Contract
Fax: (787) 782-3345
You may have purchased a service contract for a vehicle
to help protect you from the high cost of unexpected
repairs after the manufacturer’s New Vehicle Limited
Warranty expires. The manufacturer stands behind only
the manufacturer’s service contracts. If you purchased a
manufacturer’s service contract, you will receive Plan
Provisions and an Owner Identification Card in the mail
within three weeks of the vehicle delivery date. If you
have any questions about the service contract, call the
manufacturer’s Service Contract National Customer
Hotline at 1-800-521-9922 (Canadian residents, call (800)
465-2001 English / (800) 387-9983 French).
Puerto Rico And U.S. Virgin Islands
Customer Service Chrysler International Services LLC
P.O. Box 191857
Customer Assistance For The Hearing Or Speech
Impaired (TDD/TTY)
To assist customers who have hearing difficulties, the
manufacturer has installed special TDD (Telecommunication Devices for the Deaf) equipment at its customer
center. Any hearing or speech impaired customer, who
has access to a TDD or a conventional teletypewriter
(TTY) in the United States, can communicate with the
manufacturer by dialing 1-800-380-CHRY.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
9
334 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
The manufacturer will not stand behind any service
contract that is not the manufacturer’s service contract. It
is not responsible for any service contract other than the
manufacturer’s service contract. If you purchased a service contract that is not a manufacturer’s service contract,
and you require service after the manufacturer’s New
Vehicle Limited Warranty expires, please refer to the
contract documents, and contact the person listed in
those documents.
We appreciate that you have made a major investment
when you purchased the vehicle. An authorized dealer
has also made a major investment in facilities, tools, and
training to assure that you are absolutely delighted with
the ownership experience. You will be pleased with their
sincere efforts to resolve any warranty issues or related
concerns.
WARNING!
Engine exhaust (internal combustion engines only),
some of its constituents, and certain vehicle components contain, or emit, chemicals known to the State
of California to cause cancer and birth defects, or
other reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids
contained in vehicles and certain products of component wear contain, or emit, chemicals known to the
State of California to cause cancer and birth defects,
or other reproductive harm.
WARRANTY INFORMATION
See the Warranty Information Booklet, located on the
DVD, for the terms and provisions of FCA USA LLC
warranties applicable to this vehicle and market.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 335
You can also obtain other information about motor
vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov.
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS
In The 50 United States And Washington, D.C.
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect that could
cause a crash or cause injury or death, you should
immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying the
manufacturer.
In Canada
If you believe that your vehicle has a safety defect, you
should contact the Customer Service Department immediately. Canadian customers who wish to report a safety defect
to the Canadian government should contact Transport
Canada, Motor Vehicle Defect Investigations and Recalls at
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an
1-800-333-0510 or go to http://www.tc.gc.ca/roadsafety/
investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in
a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy PUBLICATION ORDER FORMS
campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in
individual problems between you, your authorized To order the following manuals, you may use either the
website or the phone numbers listed below. Visa, Masdealer, and the manufacturer.
tercard, American Express, and Discover orders are acTo contact NHTSA, you may either call the Auto Safety cepted. If you prefer mailing your payment, please call
Hotline toll free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153), for an order form.
or go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New Jersey Avenue, SE., West NOTE: A street address is required when ordering
manuals (no P.O. Boxes).
Building, Washington, D.C. 20590.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
9
336 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
Service Manuals
Owner’s Manuals
These comprehensive Service Manuals provide the information that students and professional technicians need in
diagnosing/troubleshooting, problem solving, maintaining, servicing, and repairing FCA USA LLC vehicles. A
complete working knowledge of the vehicle, system,
and/or components is written in straightforward language with illustrations, diagrams, and charts.
These Owner’s Manuals have been prepared with the
assistance of service and engineering specialists to acquaint you with specific FCA USA LLC vehicles. Included are starting, operating, emergency and maintenance procedures as well as specifications, capabilities
and safety tips.
Diagnostic Procedure Manuals
1-800-890-4038 (U.S.)
Diagnostic Procedure Manuals are filled with diagrams,
charts and detailed illustrations. These practical manuals
make it easy for students and technicians to find and fix
problems on computer-controlled vehicle systems and
features. They show exactly how to find and correct
problems the first time, using step-by-step troubleshooting and drivability procedures, proven diagnostic tests
and a complete list of all tools and equipment.
1-800-387-1143 (Canada)
• Call toll free at:
Or
• Visit us on the Worldwide Web at:
www.techauthority.com
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 337
DEPARTMENT OF TRANSPORTATION UNIFORM
TIRE QUALITY GRADES
significantly from the norm due to variations in driving
habits, service practices, and differences in road characteristics and climate.
The following tire grading categories were established by
the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration. The Traction Grades
specific grade rating assigned by the tire’s manufacturer
The Traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B,
in each category is shown on the sidewall of the tires on
and C. These grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on
your vehicle.
wet pavement, as measured under controlled conditions
All passenger vehicle tires must conform to Federal on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and
concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction perforsafety requirements in addition to these grades.
mance.
Treadwear
The Treadwear grade is a comparative rating, based on
the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled
conditions on a specified government test course. For
example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half
times as well on the government course as a tire graded
100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the
actual conditions of their use, however, and may depart
WARNING!
The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on
straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not
include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or
peak traction characteristics.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
9
338 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
Temperature Grades
WARNING!
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C,
representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat
and its ability to dissipate heat, when tested under
controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory
test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the
material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and
excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The
grade C corresponds to a level of performance, which all
passenger vehicle tires must meet under the Federal
Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A
represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory
test wheel, than the minimum required by law.
The temperature grade for this tire is established for
a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded.
Excessive speed, under-inflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause
heat buildup and possible tire failure.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
INDEX
10
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
340 INDEX
Adding Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299
Air Bag. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57, 58
Advance Front Air Bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58, 59
Air Bag Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
Air Bag Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
Driver Knee Air Bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .62
Enhanced Accident Response . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Event Data Recorder (EDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Front Air Bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57, 58
If A Deployment Occurs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
Knee Impact Bolsters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .61
Maintaining Your Air Bag System . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Air Bag Deployment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57
Air Bag Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68, 91, 144
Air Bag Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Air Conditioner Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295
Air Conditioning Refrigerant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .295
Air Conditioning System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190, 295
Air Pressure, Tires. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235
Alarm
Disarm The System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Vehicle Security Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Alarm (Security Alarm) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Alterations/Modifications, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
Anti-Lock Warning Light . . . . . . . . . .150, 156, 157, 159
Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .302
Audio Systems (Radio) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
Automatic Dimming Mirror. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Automatic Temperature Control (ATC) . . . . . . . . . .190
Automatic Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203
Gear Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149, 294
Charging System Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149
Keyless Transmitter Replacement (RKE) . . . . . . . .37
Belts, Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
INDEX 341
Body Mechanism Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
B-Pillar Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230
Brake Assist System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
Brake Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
Brake, Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .300
Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .300
Anti-Lock (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
Master Cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .300
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145
Bulb Replacement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316, 317
Bulbs, Light. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93, 316
Capacities, Fluid . . .
Cargo Area Features
Car Washes . . . . . .
Cellular Phone . . . .
Chart, Tire Sizing . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.320
.134
.303
.188
.225
Checking Your Vehicle For Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90
Checks, Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90
Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71
Child Restraints
Booster Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71
Child Seat Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87
How To Stow An Unused ALR Seat Belt . . . . . . . .84
Infants And Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Install A LATCH-Compatible Child Restraint . . . .83
Installing Child Restraints Using The Vehicle Seat
Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
Lower Anchors And Tethers For Children . . . . . . .78
Older Children And Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . .74
Seating Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
Cleaning
Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .304
Climate Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189
Clutch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .300
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
10
342 INDEX
Clutch Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .300
Compact Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241
Connector
UCI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
Universal Consumer Interface (UCI) . . . . . . . . . .170
Contract, Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .333
Cooling System
Coolant Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .320
Selection Of Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . .321
Corrosion Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .302
Cruise Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147, 149, 161, 162
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133
Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .331
Customer Programmable Features . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
Data Recorder, Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Daytime Running Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Dealer Service. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286
Defroster, Windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92
Disarming, Security System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Door Ajar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148, 150
Door Ajar Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148, 150
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
Door Locks, Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Driving
Through Flowing, Rising, Or Shallow Standing
Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
Electrical Power Outlets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129
Electric Remote Mirrors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
Electronic Brake Control System
Brake Assist System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
Electronic Speed Control (Cruise Control) . . . . . . . .118
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .219
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) . . . . . .164
Emergency, In Case Of
Hazard Warning Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
INDEX 343
Hazard
Engine
Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .285
Driving Through Flowing, Rising, Or Shallow
Standing Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202
Enhanced Accident Response Feature . . . . . . . . . . . .67 Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .307
Event Data Recorder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70
Exterior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Flashers
Turn Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93, 161 Heated Seats. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
Fluids, Lubricants And Genuine Parts . . . . . . . . . . .321 Holder, Cup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133
Fog Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113 Hood Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
Freeing A Stuck Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .309 Ignition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Gear Ranges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206 Ignition Key Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255 Immobilizer (Sentry Key) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
General Maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286 Information Center, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
Glass Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .307 Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
Instrument Panel And Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
10
344 INDEX
.307 Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93, 109
Air Bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68, 91, 144
.308
Brake Assist Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221
.305
Brake Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145
.112
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .317
Cruise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147, 149, 161, 162
Key Fob
Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93
Disarm The Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
High Beam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Key-In Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110, 160
Key, Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Seat Belt Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Key, Sentry (Immobilizer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .317
Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPMS) . . . . . . . . . . . .153
Lane Change Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Traction Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221
Lap/Shoulder Belts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Turn Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93, 110, 161
Latches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93
Warning (Instrument Cluster Description) . . . . . .161
Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
Life Of Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244 Loading Vehicle
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230
Liftgate (Sedan) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43
Light Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93, 316
Instrument Panel Cover . . . . . . .
Instrument Panel Lens Cleaning .
Interior Appearance Care . . . . . .
Interior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
INDEX 345
Locks
Automatic Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .39
Power Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Lubrication, Body . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
Lug Nuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
Maintenance Free Battery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .294
Maintenance, General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286
Maintenance Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286
Maintenance Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .324
Manual, Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .335
Master Cylinder (Brakes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .300
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Automatic Dimming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
Electric Powered . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
Modifications/Alterations, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8
Multi-Function Control Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
Occupant Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
Operator Manual (Owner’s Manual) . . . . . . . . . . . . .5
Owner’s Manual (Operator Manual) . . . . . . . . . .5, 335
Paint Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .302
Parking Brake. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
Passing Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Pets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90
Placard, Tire And Loading Information . . . . . . . . . .231
Power
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99
Outlet (Auxiliary Electrical Outlet) . . . . . . . . . . .129
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
Pregnant Women And Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
10
346 INDEX
Replacement Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
Reporting Safety Defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .335
Restraints, Child . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71
Radial Ply Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237 Restraints, Occupant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
Rotation, Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248
Radio Frequency
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34, 39
Radio Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188 Safety Checks Inside Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
Rear Liftgate (Sedan) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43 Safety Checks Outside Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93
Rear Window Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136 Safety Defects, Reporting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .335
Recorder, Event Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70 Safety Information, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
Recreational Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256 Safety Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90
Release, Hood. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106 Schedule, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .324
Reminder, Seat Belt. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46 Seat Belt
Energy Management Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
Lap/Shoulder Belt Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50
Disarm The Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Lap/Shoulder Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Remote Sound System (Radio) Controls . . . . . . . . .187
Lap/Shoulder Belt Untwisting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52
Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316
Pregnant Women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
Replacement Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .34
Seat Belt Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53
Replacement Parts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286
Pretensioners
Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
INDEX 347
Seat Belt Pretensioner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
Seat Belt Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Seat Belt System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .44
Seat Belt Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .308
Seat Belt Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46
Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46, 91
Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .71
Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53
Front Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .46, 48, 50
Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
Operating Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50
Pregnant Women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
Pretensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Untwisting Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
Security Alarm
Disarm The System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Security Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Selection Of Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
Sentry Key (Immobilizer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Service Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .331
Service Contract . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .333
Service Manuals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .335
Shoulder Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Signals, Turn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93, 110, 161
Snow Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240, 241, 242
Speed Control
Accel/Decel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121
Resume . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119
Speed Control (Cruise Control). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202
Steering
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .212
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
10
348 INDEX
Tilt Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117
Wheel, Tilt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117
Steering Wheel Audio Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .187
Steering Wheel Mounted Sound System Controls . . .187
Storage, Vehicle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
Stuck, Freeing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278
Sun Roof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126
Supplemental Restraint System - Air Bag . . . . . . . . .58
Temperature Control, Automatic (ATC) . . . . . . . . . .190
Tilt Steering Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .117
Tire And Loading Information Placard . . . . . . .230, 231
Tire Markings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93, 234, 240, 337
Aging (Life Of Tires) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244
Air Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
Compact Spare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234, 240
High Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237
Inflation Pressures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .235
Life Of Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .244
Load Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230, 231
Pressure Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153
Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .337
Radial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248
Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223, 234
Sizes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
Snow Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .239
Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240, 242
Spinning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243
Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243
Tire Safety Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .223
Tire Service Kit . . . . . . .264, 265, 266, 268, 269, 272, 273
To Open Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
Disabled Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
INDEX 349
Recreational . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256
Towing Vehicle Behind A Motorhome . . . . . . . . . . .256
Traction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .210
Traction Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .218
Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
Transaxle
Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Transmission
Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
Transmitter Battery Service
(Remote Keyless Entry) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
Transporting Pets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90
Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .243
Turn Signals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110, 161
Untwisting Procedure, Seat Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52
Vehicle
Vehicle
Vehicle
Vehicle
Vehicle
Identification Number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
Modifications/Alterations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8
Security Alarm Disarming . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
Warnings And Cautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Warranty Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .334
Washers, Windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114, 116
Washing Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .303
Water
Driving Through . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
Wheel And Wheel Trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .304
Wheel And Wheel Trim Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .304
UCI Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170 Wind Buffeting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .43, 128
Uniform Tire Quality Grades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .337 Window Fogging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .195
Universal Consumer Interface (UCI) Connector . . . .170
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
10
350 INDEX
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .42
Windshield Defroster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92
Windshield Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114, 116
Windshield Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
Windshield Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
INSTALLATION OF RADIO TRANSMITTING
EQUIPMENT
Special design considerations are incorporated into this
vehicle’s electronic system to provide immunity to radio
frequency signals. Mobile two-way radios and telephone
equipment must be installed properly by trained personnel. The following must be observed during installation.
The positive power connection should be made directly
to the battery and fused as close to the battery as possible.
The negative power connection should be made to body
sheet metal adjacent to the negative battery connection.
This connection should not be fused.
Antennas for two-way radios should be mounted on the
roof or the rear area of the vehicle. Care should be used
in mounting antennas with magnet bases. Magnets may
affect the accuracy or operation of the compass on
vehicles so equipped.
The antenna cable should be as short as practical and
routed away from the vehicle wiring when possible. Use
only fully shielded coaxial cable.
Carefully match the antenna and cable to the radio to
ensure a low Standing Wave Ratio (SWR).
Mobile radio equipment with output power greater than
normal may require special precautions.
All installations should be checked for possible interference between the communications equipment and the
vehicle’s electronic systems.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
16BEV24-126-AB
16BEV24-126-AA
©2015 FCA US LLC. All Rights Reserved.
FIAT is a registered trademark of Fiat Group Marketing
& Corporate Communication S.p.A., used under license by FCA US LLC.
I
nf
or
mat
i
onPr
ovi
dedby:
Second
First Edition
Edition
Printed in U.S.A.